Regenerate Makefile.in/aclocal.m4 automake 1.11.6
[external/binutils.git] / gold / mips.cc
1 // mips.cc -- mips target support for gold.
2
3 // Copyright (C) 2011-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 // Written by Sasa Stankovic <sasa.stankovic@imgtec.com>
5 //        and Aleksandar Simeonov <aleksandar.simeonov@rt-rk.com>.
6 // This file contains borrowed and adapted code from bfd/elfxx-mips.c.
7
8 // This file is part of gold.
9
10 // This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
11 // it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
12 // the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
13 // (at your option) any later version.
14
15 // This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
16 // but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
17 // MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
18 // GNU General Public License for more details.
19
20 // You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 // along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
22 // Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
23 // MA 02110-1301, USA.
24
25 #include "gold.h"
26
27 #include <algorithm>
28 #include <set>
29 #include <sstream>
30 #include "demangle.h"
31
32 #include "elfcpp.h"
33 #include "parameters.h"
34 #include "reloc.h"
35 #include "mips.h"
36 #include "object.h"
37 #include "symtab.h"
38 #include "layout.h"
39 #include "output.h"
40 #include "copy-relocs.h"
41 #include "target.h"
42 #include "target-reloc.h"
43 #include "target-select.h"
44 #include "tls.h"
45 #include "errors.h"
46 #include "gc.h"
47 #include "nacl.h"
48
49 namespace
50 {
51 using namespace gold;
52
53 template<int size, bool big_endian>
54 class Mips_output_data_plt;
55
56 template<int size, bool big_endian>
57 class Mips_output_data_got;
58
59 template<int size, bool big_endian>
60 class Target_mips;
61
62 template<int size, bool big_endian>
63 class Mips_output_section_reginfo;
64
65 template<int size, bool big_endian>
66 class Mips_output_data_la25_stub;
67
68 template<int size, bool big_endian>
69 class Mips_output_data_mips_stubs;
70
71 template<int size>
72 class Mips_symbol;
73
74 template<int size, bool big_endian>
75 class Mips_got_info;
76
77 template<int size, bool big_endian>
78 class Mips_relobj;
79
80 class Mips16_stub_section_base;
81
82 template<int size, bool big_endian>
83 class Mips16_stub_section;
84
85 // The ABI says that every symbol used by dynamic relocations must have
86 // a global GOT entry.  Among other things, this provides the dynamic
87 // linker with a free, directly-indexed cache.  The GOT can therefore
88 // contain symbols that are not referenced by GOT relocations themselves
89 // (in other words, it may have symbols that are not referenced by things
90 // like R_MIPS_GOT16 and R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE).
91
92 // GOT relocations are less likely to overflow if we put the associated
93 // GOT entries towards the beginning.  We therefore divide the global
94 // GOT entries into two areas: "normal" and "reloc-only".  Entries in
95 // the first area can be used for both dynamic relocations and GP-relative
96 // accesses, while those in the "reloc-only" area are for dynamic
97 // relocations only.
98
99 // These GGA_* ("Global GOT Area") values are organised so that lower
100 // values are more general than higher values.  Also, non-GGA_NONE
101 // values are ordered by the position of the area in the GOT.
102
103 enum Global_got_area
104 {
105   GGA_NORMAL = 0,
106   GGA_RELOC_ONLY = 1,
107   GGA_NONE = 2
108 };
109
110 // The types of GOT entries needed for this platform.
111 // These values are exposed to the ABI in an incremental link.
112 // Do not renumber existing values without changing the version
113 // number of the .gnu_incremental_inputs section.
114 enum Got_type
115 {
116   GOT_TYPE_STANDARD = 0,      // GOT entry for a regular symbol
117   GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET = 1,    // GOT entry for TLS offset
118   GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR = 2,      // GOT entry for TLS module/offset pair
119
120   // GOT entries for multi-GOT. We support up to 1024 GOTs in multi-GOT links.
121   GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT = 3,
122   GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET_MULTIGOT = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT + 1024,
123   GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR_MULTIGOT = GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET_MULTIGOT + 1024
124 };
125
126 // TLS type of GOT entry.
127 enum Got_tls_type
128 {
129   GOT_TLS_NONE = 0,
130   GOT_TLS_GD = 1,
131   GOT_TLS_LDM = 2,
132   GOT_TLS_IE = 4
133 };
134
135 // Values found in the r_ssym field of a relocation entry.
136 enum Special_relocation_symbol
137 {
138   RSS_UNDEF = 0,    // None - value is zero.
139   RSS_GP = 1,       // Value of GP.
140   RSS_GP0 = 2,      // Value of GP in object being relocated.
141   RSS_LOC = 3       // Address of location being relocated.
142 };
143
144 // Whether the section is readonly.
145 static inline bool
146 is_readonly_section(Output_section* output_section)
147 {
148   elfcpp::Elf_Xword section_flags = output_section->flags();
149   elfcpp::Elf_Word section_type = output_section->type();
150
151   if (section_type == elfcpp::SHT_NOBITS)
152     return false;
153
154   if (section_flags & elfcpp::SHF_WRITE)
155     return false;
156
157   return true;
158 }
159
160 // Return TRUE if a relocation of type R_TYPE from OBJECT might
161 // require an la25 stub.  See also local_pic_function, which determines
162 // whether the destination function ever requires a stub.
163 template<int size, bool big_endian>
164 static inline bool
165 relocation_needs_la25_stub(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
166                            unsigned int r_type, bool target_is_16_bit_code)
167 {
168   // We specifically ignore branches and jumps from EF_PIC objects,
169   // where the onus is on the compiler or programmer to perform any
170   // necessary initialization of $25.  Sometimes such initialization
171   // is unnecessary; for example, -mno-shared functions do not use
172   // the incoming value of $25, and may therefore be called directly.
173   if (object->is_pic())
174     return false;
175
176   switch (r_type)
177     {
178     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
179     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC16:
180     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
181     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
182     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
183     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
184     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
185       return true;
186
187     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
188       return !target_is_16_bit_code;
189
190     default:
191       return false;
192     }
193 }
194
195 // Return true if SYM is a locally-defined PIC function, in the sense
196 // that it or its fn_stub might need $25 to be valid on entry.
197 // Note that MIPS16 functions set up $gp using PC-relative instructions,
198 // so they themselves never need $25 to be valid.  Only non-MIPS16
199 // entry points are of interest here.
200 template<int size, bool big_endian>
201 static inline bool
202 local_pic_function(Mips_symbol<size>* sym)
203 {
204   bool def_regular = (sym->source() == Symbol::FROM_OBJECT
205                       && !sym->object()->is_dynamic()
206                       && !sym->is_undefined());
207
208   if (sym->is_defined() && def_regular)
209     {
210       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
211         static_cast<Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*>(sym->object());
212
213       if ((object->is_pic() || sym->is_pic())
214           && (!sym->is_mips16()
215               || (sym->has_mips16_fn_stub() && sym->need_fn_stub())))
216         return true;
217     }
218   return false;
219 }
220
221 static inline bool
222 hi16_reloc(int r_type)
223 {
224   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16
225           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16
226           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16);
227 }
228
229 static inline bool
230 lo16_reloc(int r_type)
231 {
232   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16
233           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16
234           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16);
235 }
236
237 static inline bool
238 got16_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
239 {
240   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16
241           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16
242           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16);
243 }
244
245 static inline bool
246 call_lo16_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
247 {
248   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16
249           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16);
250 }
251
252 static inline bool
253 got_lo16_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
254 {
255   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16
256           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16);
257 }
258
259 static inline bool
260 eh_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
261 {
262   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH);
263 }
264
265 static inline bool
266 got_disp_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
267 {
268   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP
269           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP);
270 }
271
272 static inline bool
273 got_page_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
274 {
275   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE
276           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE);
277 }
278
279 static inline bool
280 tls_gd_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
281 {
282   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD
283           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD
284           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD);
285 }
286
287 static inline bool
288 tls_gottprel_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
289 {
290   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL
291           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL
292           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL);
293 }
294
295 static inline bool
296 tls_ldm_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
297 {
298   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
299           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM
300           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM);
301 }
302
303 static inline bool
304 mips16_call_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
305 {
306   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26
307           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16);
308 }
309
310 static inline bool
311 jal_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
312 {
313   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_26
314           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26
315           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1);
316 }
317
318 static inline bool
319 micromips_branch_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
320 {
321   return (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
322           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
323           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
324           || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
325 }
326
327 // Check if R_TYPE is a MIPS16 reloc.
328 static inline bool
329 mips16_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
330 {
331   switch (r_type)
332     {
333     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
334     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GPREL:
335     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
336     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
337     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
338     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16:
339     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
340     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
341     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
342     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
343     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
344     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
345     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
346       return true;
347
348     default:
349       return false;
350     }
351 }
352
353 // Check if R_TYPE is a microMIPS reloc.
354 static inline bool
355 micromips_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
356 {
357   switch (r_type)
358     {
359     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
360     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
361     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
362     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
363     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
364     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
365     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
366     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
367     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
368     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
369     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
370     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
371     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
372     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
373     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
374     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_SUB:
375     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
376     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
377     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
378     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
379     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_SCN_DISP:
380     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
381     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16:
382     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
383     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
384     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
385     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
386     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
387     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
388     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
389     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
390     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
391       return true;
392
393     default:
394       return false;
395     }
396 }
397
398 static inline bool
399 is_matching_lo16_reloc(unsigned int high_reloc, unsigned int lo16_reloc)
400 {
401   switch (high_reloc)
402     {
403     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
404     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
405       return lo16_reloc == elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16;
406     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
407     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
408       return lo16_reloc == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16;
409     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
410     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
411       return lo16_reloc == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16;
412     default:
413       return false;
414     }
415 }
416
417 // This class is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
418 // There are three types of entry:
419 //
420 //    (1) a SYMBOL + OFFSET address, where SYMBOL is local to an input object
421 //          (object != NULL, symndx >= 0, tls_type != GOT_TLS_LDM)
422 //    (2) a SYMBOL address, where SYMBOL is not local to an input object
423 //          (object != NULL, symndx == -1)
424 //    (3) a TLS LDM slot
425 //          (object != NULL, symndx == 0, tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM)
426
427 template<int size, bool big_endian>
428 class Mips_got_entry
429 {
430   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
431
432  public:
433   Mips_got_entry(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object, unsigned int symndx,
434                  Mips_address addend, unsigned char tls_type,
435                  unsigned int shndx, bool is_section_symbol)
436     : object_(object), symndx_(symndx), tls_type_(tls_type),
437       is_section_symbol_(is_section_symbol), shndx_(shndx)
438   { this->d.addend = addend; }
439
440   Mips_got_entry(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object, Mips_symbol<size>* sym,
441                  unsigned char tls_type)
442     : object_(object), symndx_(-1U), tls_type_(tls_type),
443       is_section_symbol_(false), shndx_(-1U)
444   { this->d.sym = sym; }
445
446   // Return whether this entry is for a local symbol.
447   bool
448   is_for_local_symbol() const
449   { return this->symndx_ != -1U; }
450
451   // Return whether this entry is for a global symbol.
452   bool
453   is_for_global_symbol() const
454   { return this->symndx_ == -1U; }
455
456   // Return the hash of this entry.
457   size_t
458   hash() const
459   {
460     if (this->tls_type_ == GOT_TLS_LDM)
461       return this->symndx_ + (1 << 18);
462     if (this->symndx_ != -1U)
463       {
464         uintptr_t object_id = reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(this->object());
465         return this->symndx_ + object_id + this->d.addend;
466       }
467     else
468       {
469         uintptr_t sym_id = reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(this->d.sym);
470         return this->symndx_ + sym_id;
471       }
472   }
473
474   // Return whether this entry is equal to OTHER.
475   bool
476   equals(Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* other) const
477   {
478     if (this->symndx_ != other->symndx_
479         || this->tls_type_ != other->tls_type_)
480       return false;
481     if (this->tls_type_ == GOT_TLS_LDM)
482       return true;
483     if (this->symndx_ != -1U)
484       return (this->object() == other->object()
485               && this->d.addend == other->d.addend);
486     else
487       return this->d.sym == other->d.sym;
488   }
489
490   // Return input object that needs this GOT entry.
491   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*
492   object() const
493   {
494     gold_assert(this->object_ != NULL);
495     return this->object_;
496   }
497
498   // Return local symbol index for local GOT entries.
499   unsigned int
500   symndx() const
501   {
502     gold_assert(this->symndx_ != -1U);
503     return this->symndx_;
504   }
505
506   // Return the relocation addend for local GOT entries.
507   Mips_address
508   addend() const
509   {
510     gold_assert(this->symndx_ != -1U);
511     return this->d.addend;
512   }
513
514   // Return global symbol for global GOT entries.
515   Mips_symbol<size>*
516   sym() const
517   {
518     gold_assert(this->symndx_ == -1U);
519     return this->d.sym;
520   }
521
522   // Return whether this is a TLS GOT entry.
523   bool
524   is_tls_entry() const
525   { return this->tls_type_ != GOT_TLS_NONE; }
526
527   // Return TLS type of this GOT entry.
528   unsigned char
529   tls_type() const
530   { return this->tls_type_; }
531
532   // Return section index of the local symbol for local GOT entries.
533   unsigned int
534   shndx() const
535   { return this->shndx_; }
536
537   // Return whether this is a STT_SECTION symbol.
538   bool
539   is_section_symbol() const
540   { return this->is_section_symbol_; }
541
542  private:
543   // The input object that needs the GOT entry.
544   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object_;
545   // The index of the symbol if we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise.
546   unsigned int symndx_;
547
548   union
549   {
550     // If symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation that should be added to the
551     // symbol value.
552     Mips_address addend;
553     // If symndx == -1, the global symbol corresponding to this GOT entry.  The
554     // symbol's entry is in the local area if mips_sym->global_got_area is
555     // GGA_NONE, otherwise it is in the global area.
556     Mips_symbol<size>* sym;
557   } d;
558
559   // The TLS type of this GOT entry.  An LDM GOT entry will be a local
560   // symbol entry with r_symndx == 0.
561   unsigned char tls_type_;
562
563   // Whether this is a STT_SECTION symbol.
564   bool is_section_symbol_;
565
566   // For local GOT entries, section index of the local symbol.
567   unsigned int shndx_;
568 };
569
570 // Hash for Mips_got_entry.
571
572 template<int size, bool big_endian>
573 class Mips_got_entry_hash
574 {
575  public:
576   size_t
577   operator()(Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry) const
578   { return entry->hash(); }
579 };
580
581 // Equality for Mips_got_entry.
582
583 template<int size, bool big_endian>
584 class Mips_got_entry_eq
585 {
586  public:
587   bool
588   operator()(Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* e1,
589              Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* e2) const
590   { return e1->equals(e2); }
591 };
592
593 // Got_page_range.  This class describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND,
594 // MAX_ADDEND].  The instances form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by
595 // increasing MIN_ADDEND.
596
597 struct Got_page_range
598 {
599   Got_page_range()
600     : next(NULL), min_addend(0), max_addend(0)
601   { }
602
603   Got_page_range* next;
604   int min_addend;
605   int max_addend;
606
607   // Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required.
608   int
609   get_max_pages()
610   { return (this->max_addend - this->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16; }
611 };
612
613 // Got_page_entry.  This class describes the range of addends that are applied
614 // to page relocations against a given symbol.
615
616 struct Got_page_entry
617 {
618   Got_page_entry()
619     : object(NULL), symndx(-1U), ranges(NULL), num_pages(0)
620   { }
621
622   Got_page_entry(Object* object_, unsigned int symndx_)
623     : object(object_), symndx(symndx_), ranges(NULL), num_pages(0)
624   { }
625
626   // The input object that needs the GOT page entry.
627   Object* object;
628   // The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info.
629   unsigned int symndx;
630   // The ranges for this page entry.
631   Got_page_range* ranges;
632   // The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES.
633   unsigned int num_pages;
634 };
635
636 // Hash for Got_page_entry.
637
638 struct Got_page_entry_hash
639 {
640   size_t
641   operator()(Got_page_entry* entry) const
642   { return reinterpret_cast<uintptr_t>(entry->object) + entry->symndx; }
643 };
644
645 // Equality for Got_page_entry.
646
647 struct Got_page_entry_eq
648 {
649   bool
650   operator()(Got_page_entry* entry1, Got_page_entry* entry2) const
651   {
652     return entry1->object == entry2->object && entry1->symndx == entry2->symndx;
653   }
654 };
655
656 // This class is used to hold .got information when linking.
657
658 template<int size, bool big_endian>
659 class Mips_got_info
660 {
661   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
662   typedef Output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true, size, big_endian>
663     Reloc_section;
664   typedef Unordered_map<unsigned int, unsigned int> Got_page_offsets;
665
666   // Unordered set of GOT entries.
667   typedef Unordered_set<Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>*,
668       Mips_got_entry_hash<size, big_endian>,
669       Mips_got_entry_eq<size, big_endian> > Got_entry_set;
670
671   // Unordered set of GOT page entries.
672   typedef Unordered_set<Got_page_entry*,
673       Got_page_entry_hash, Got_page_entry_eq> Got_page_entry_set;
674
675  public:
676   Mips_got_info()
677     : local_gotno_(0), page_gotno_(0), global_gotno_(0), reloc_only_gotno_(0),
678       tls_gotno_(0), tls_ldm_offset_(-1U), global_got_symbols_(),
679       got_entries_(), got_page_entries_(), got_page_offset_start_(0),
680       got_page_offset_next_(0), got_page_offsets_(), next_(NULL), index_(-1U),
681       offset_(0)
682   { }
683
684   // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against symbol
685   // SYMNDX + ADDEND, where SYMNDX is a local symbol in section SHNDX in OBJECT.
686   void
687   record_local_got_symbol(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
688                           unsigned int symndx, Mips_address addend,
689                           unsigned int r_type, unsigned int shndx,
690                           bool is_section_symbol);
691
692   // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against MIPS_SYM,
693   // in OBJECT.  FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
694   // using the GOT entry for calls.  DYN_RELOC is true if R_TYPE is a dynamic
695   // relocation.
696   void
697   record_global_got_symbol(Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym,
698                            Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
699                            unsigned int r_type, bool dyn_reloc, bool for_call);
700
701   // Add ENTRY to master GOT and to OBJECT's GOT.
702   void
703   record_got_entry(Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry,
704                    Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object);
705
706   // Record that OBJECT has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
707   // that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation.
708   void
709   record_got_page_entry(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
710                         unsigned int symndx, int addend);
711
712   // Create all entries that should be in the local part of the GOT.
713   void
714   add_local_entries(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout);
715
716   // Create GOT page entries.
717   void
718   add_page_entries(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout);
719
720   // Create global GOT entries, both GGA_NORMAL and GGA_RELOC_ONLY.
721   void
722   add_global_entries(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout,
723                      unsigned int non_reloc_only_global_gotno);
724
725   // Create global GOT entries that should be in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area.
726   void
727   add_reloc_only_entries(Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got);
728
729   // Create TLS GOT entries.
730   void
731   add_tls_entries(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout);
732
733   // Decide whether the symbol needs an entry in the global part of the primary
734   // GOT, setting global_got_area accordingly.  Count the number of global
735   // symbols that are in the primary GOT only because they have dynamic
736   // relocations R_MIPS_REL32 against them (reloc_only_gotno).
737   void
738   count_got_symbols(Symbol_table* symtab);
739
740   // Return the offset of GOT page entry for VALUE.
741   unsigned int
742   get_got_page_offset(Mips_address value,
743                       Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got);
744
745   // Count the number of GOT entries required.
746   void
747   count_got_entries();
748
749   // Count the number of GOT entries required by ENTRY.  Accumulate the result.
750   void
751   count_got_entry(Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry);
752
753   // Add FROM's GOT entries.
754   void
755   add_got_entries(Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from);
756
757   // Add FROM's GOT page entries.
758   void
759   add_got_page_entries(Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from);
760
761   // Return GOT size.
762   unsigned int
763   got_size() const
764   { return ((2 + this->local_gotno_ + this->page_gotno_ + this->global_gotno_
765              + this->tls_gotno_) * size/8);
766   }
767
768   // Return the number of local GOT entries.
769   unsigned int
770   local_gotno() const
771   { return this->local_gotno_; }
772
773   // Return the maximum number of page GOT entries needed.
774   unsigned int
775   page_gotno() const
776   { return this->page_gotno_; }
777
778   // Return the number of global GOT entries.
779   unsigned int
780   global_gotno() const
781   { return this->global_gotno_; }
782
783   // Set the number of global GOT entries.
784   void
785   set_global_gotno(unsigned int global_gotno)
786   { this->global_gotno_ = global_gotno; }
787
788   // Return the number of GGA_RELOC_ONLY global GOT entries.
789   unsigned int
790   reloc_only_gotno() const
791   { return this->reloc_only_gotno_; }
792
793   // Return the number of TLS GOT entries.
794   unsigned int
795   tls_gotno() const
796   { return this->tls_gotno_; }
797
798   // Return the GOT type for this GOT.  Used for multi-GOT links only.
799   unsigned int
800   multigot_got_type(unsigned int got_type) const
801   {
802     switch (got_type)
803       {
804       case GOT_TYPE_STANDARD:
805         return GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
806       case GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET:
807         return GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
808       case GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR:
809         return GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
810       default:
811         gold_unreachable();
812       }
813   }
814
815   // Remove lazy-binding stubs for global symbols in this GOT.
816   void
817   remove_lazy_stubs(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target);
818
819   // Return offset of this GOT from the start of .got section.
820   unsigned int
821   offset() const
822   { return this->offset_; }
823
824   // Set offset of this GOT from the start of .got section.
825   void
826   set_offset(unsigned int offset)
827   { this->offset_ = offset; }
828
829   // Set index of this GOT in multi-GOT links.
830   void
831   set_index(unsigned int index)
832   { this->index_ = index; }
833
834   // Return next GOT in multi-GOT links.
835   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>*
836   next() const
837   { return this->next_; }
838
839   // Set next GOT in multi-GOT links.
840   void
841   set_next(Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* next)
842   { this->next_ = next; }
843
844   // Return the offset of TLS LDM entry for this GOT.
845   unsigned int
846   tls_ldm_offset() const
847   { return this->tls_ldm_offset_; }
848
849   // Set the offset of TLS LDM entry for this GOT.
850   void
851   set_tls_ldm_offset(unsigned int tls_ldm_offset)
852   { this->tls_ldm_offset_ = tls_ldm_offset; }
853
854   Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>&
855   global_got_symbols()
856   { return this->global_got_symbols_; }
857
858   // Return the GOT_TLS_* type required by relocation type R_TYPE.
859   static int
860   mips_elf_reloc_tls_type(unsigned int r_type)
861   {
862     if (tls_gd_reloc(r_type))
863       return GOT_TLS_GD;
864
865     if (tls_ldm_reloc(r_type))
866       return GOT_TLS_LDM;
867
868     if (tls_gottprel_reloc(r_type))
869       return GOT_TLS_IE;
870
871     return GOT_TLS_NONE;
872   }
873
874   // Return the number of GOT slots needed for GOT TLS type TYPE.
875   static int
876   mips_tls_got_entries(unsigned int type)
877   {
878     switch (type)
879       {
880       case GOT_TLS_GD:
881       case GOT_TLS_LDM:
882         return 2;
883
884       case GOT_TLS_IE:
885         return 1;
886
887       case GOT_TLS_NONE:
888         return 0;
889
890       default:
891         gold_unreachable();
892       }
893   }
894
895  private:
896   // The number of local GOT entries.
897   unsigned int local_gotno_;
898   // The maximum number of page GOT entries needed.
899   unsigned int page_gotno_;
900   // The number of global GOT entries.
901   unsigned int global_gotno_;
902   // The number of global GOT entries that are in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area.
903   unsigned int reloc_only_gotno_;
904   // The number of TLS GOT entries.
905   unsigned int tls_gotno_;
906   // The offset of TLS LDM entry for this GOT.
907   unsigned int tls_ldm_offset_;
908   // All symbols that have global GOT entry.
909   Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*> global_got_symbols_;
910   // A hash table holding GOT entries.
911   Got_entry_set got_entries_;
912   // A hash table of GOT page entries.
913   Got_page_entry_set got_page_entries_;
914   // The offset of first GOT page entry for this GOT.
915   unsigned int got_page_offset_start_;
916   // The offset of next available GOT page entry for this GOT.
917   unsigned int got_page_offset_next_;
918   // A hash table that maps GOT page entry value to the GOT offset where
919   // the entry is located.
920   Got_page_offsets got_page_offsets_;
921   // In multi-GOT links, a pointer to the next GOT.
922   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* next_;
923   // Index of this GOT in multi-GOT links.
924   unsigned int index_;
925   // The offset of this GOT in multi-GOT links.
926   unsigned int offset_;
927 };
928
929 // This is a helper class used during relocation scan.  It records GOT16 addend.
930
931 template<int size, bool big_endian>
932 struct got16_addend
933 {
934   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
935
936   got16_addend(const Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* _object,
937                unsigned int _shndx, unsigned int _r_type, unsigned int _r_sym,
938                Mips_address _addend)
939     : object(_object), shndx(_shndx), r_type(_r_type), r_sym(_r_sym),
940       addend(_addend)
941   { }
942
943   const Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object;
944   unsigned int shndx;
945   unsigned int r_type;
946   unsigned int r_sym;
947   Mips_address addend;
948 };
949
950 // Mips_symbol class.  Holds additional symbol information needed for Mips.
951
952 template<int size>
953 class Mips_symbol : public Sized_symbol<size>
954 {
955  public:
956   Mips_symbol()
957     : need_fn_stub_(false), has_nonpic_branches_(false), la25_stub_offset_(-1U),
958       has_static_relocs_(false), no_lazy_stub_(false), lazy_stub_offset_(0),
959       pointer_equality_needed_(false), global_got_area_(GGA_NONE),
960       global_gotoffset_(-1U), got_only_for_calls_(true), has_lazy_stub_(false),
961       needs_mips_plt_(false), needs_comp_plt_(false), mips_plt_offset_(-1U),
962       comp_plt_offset_(-1U), mips16_fn_stub_(NULL), mips16_call_stub_(NULL),
963       mips16_call_fp_stub_(NULL), applied_secondary_got_fixup_(false)
964   { }
965
966   // Return whether this is a MIPS16 symbol.
967   bool
968   is_mips16() const
969   {
970     // (st_other & STO_MIPS16) == STO_MIPS16
971     return ((this->nonvis() & (elfcpp::STO_MIPS16 >> 2))
972             == elfcpp::STO_MIPS16 >> 2);
973   }
974
975   // Return whether this is a microMIPS symbol.
976   bool
977   is_micromips() const
978   {
979     // (st_other & STO_MIPS_ISA) == STO_MICROMIPS
980     return ((this->nonvis() & (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_ISA >> 2))
981             == elfcpp::STO_MICROMIPS >> 2);
982   }
983
984   // Return whether the symbol needs MIPS16 fn_stub.
985   bool
986   need_fn_stub() const
987   { return this->need_fn_stub_; }
988
989   // Set that the symbol needs MIPS16 fn_stub.
990   void
991   set_need_fn_stub()
992   { this->need_fn_stub_ = true; }
993
994   // Return whether this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
995   // any non-PIC input file.
996   bool
997   has_nonpic_branches() const
998   { return this->has_nonpic_branches_; }
999
1000   // Set that this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
1001   // any non-PIC input file.
1002   void
1003   set_has_nonpic_branches()
1004   { this->has_nonpic_branches_ = true; }
1005
1006   // Return the offset of the la25 stub for this symbol from the start of the
1007   // la25 stub section.
1008   unsigned int
1009   la25_stub_offset() const
1010   { return this->la25_stub_offset_; }
1011
1012   // Set the offset of the la25 stub for this symbol from the start of the
1013   // la25 stub section.
1014   void
1015   set_la25_stub_offset(unsigned int offset)
1016   { this->la25_stub_offset_ = offset; }
1017
1018   // Return whether the symbol has la25 stub.  This is true if this symbol is
1019   // for a PIC function, and there are non-PIC branches and jumps to it.
1020   bool
1021   has_la25_stub() const
1022   { return this->la25_stub_offset_ != -1U; }
1023
1024   // Return whether there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
1025   // resolved by the static linker (that is, the relocation cannot possibly
1026   // be made dynamic).
1027   bool
1028   has_static_relocs() const
1029   { return this->has_static_relocs_; }
1030
1031   // Set that there is a relocation against this symbol that must be resolved
1032   // by the static linker (that is, the relocation cannot possibly be made
1033   // dynamic).
1034   void
1035   set_has_static_relocs()
1036   { this->has_static_relocs_ = true; }
1037
1038   // Return whether we must not create a lazy-binding stub for this symbol.
1039   bool
1040   no_lazy_stub() const
1041   { return this->no_lazy_stub_; }
1042
1043   // Set that we must not create a lazy-binding stub for this symbol.
1044   void
1045   set_no_lazy_stub()
1046   { this->no_lazy_stub_ = true; }
1047
1048   // Return the offset of the lazy-binding stub for this symbol from the start
1049   // of .MIPS.stubs section.
1050   unsigned int
1051   lazy_stub_offset() const
1052   { return this->lazy_stub_offset_; }
1053
1054   // Set the offset of the lazy-binding stub for this symbol from the start
1055   // of .MIPS.stubs section.
1056   void
1057   set_lazy_stub_offset(unsigned int offset)
1058   { this->lazy_stub_offset_ = offset; }
1059
1060   // Return whether there are any relocations for this symbol where
1061   // pointer equality matters.
1062   bool
1063   pointer_equality_needed() const
1064   { return this->pointer_equality_needed_; }
1065
1066   // Set that there are relocations for this symbol where pointer equality
1067   // matters.
1068   void
1069   set_pointer_equality_needed()
1070   { this->pointer_equality_needed_ = true; }
1071
1072   // Return global GOT area where this symbol in located.
1073   Global_got_area
1074   global_got_area() const
1075   { return this->global_got_area_; }
1076
1077   // Set global GOT area where this symbol in located.
1078   void
1079   set_global_got_area(Global_got_area global_got_area)
1080   { this->global_got_area_ = global_got_area; }
1081
1082   // Return the global GOT offset for this symbol.  For multi-GOT links, this
1083   // returns the offset from the start of .got section to the first GOT entry
1084   // for the symbol.  Note that in multi-GOT links the symbol can have entry
1085   // in more than one GOT.
1086   unsigned int
1087   global_gotoffset() const
1088   { return this->global_gotoffset_; }
1089
1090   // Set the global GOT offset for this symbol.  Note that in multi-GOT links
1091   // the symbol can have entry in more than one GOT.  This method will set
1092   // the offset only if it is less than current offset.
1093   void
1094   set_global_gotoffset(unsigned int offset)
1095   {
1096     if (this->global_gotoffset_ == -1U || offset < this->global_gotoffset_)
1097       this->global_gotoffset_ = offset;
1098   }
1099
1100   // Return whether all GOT relocations for this symbol are for calls.
1101   bool
1102   got_only_for_calls() const
1103   { return this->got_only_for_calls_; }
1104
1105   // Set that there is a GOT relocation for this symbol that is not for call.
1106   void
1107   set_got_not_only_for_calls()
1108   { this->got_only_for_calls_ = false; }
1109
1110   // Return whether this is a PIC symbol.
1111   bool
1112   is_pic() const
1113   {
1114     // (st_other & STO_MIPS_FLAGS) == STO_MIPS_PIC
1115     return ((this->nonvis() & (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_FLAGS >> 2))
1116             == (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_PIC >> 2));
1117   }
1118
1119   // Set the flag in st_other field that marks this symbol as PIC.
1120   void
1121   set_pic()
1122   {
1123     if (this->is_mips16())
1124       // (st_other & ~(STO_MIPS16 | STO_MIPS_FLAGS)) | STO_MIPS_PIC
1125       this->set_nonvis((this->nonvis()
1126                         & ~((elfcpp::STO_MIPS16 >> 2)
1127                             | (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_FLAGS >> 2)))
1128                        | (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_PIC >> 2));
1129     else
1130       // (other & ~STO_MIPS_FLAGS) | STO_MIPS_PIC
1131       this->set_nonvis((this->nonvis() & ~(elfcpp::STO_MIPS_FLAGS >> 2))
1132                        | (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_PIC >> 2));
1133   }
1134
1135   // Set the flag in st_other field that marks this symbol as PLT.
1136   void
1137   set_mips_plt()
1138   {
1139     if (this->is_mips16())
1140       // (st_other & (STO_MIPS16 | ~STO_MIPS_FLAGS)) | STO_MIPS_PLT
1141       this->set_nonvis((this->nonvis()
1142                         & ((elfcpp::STO_MIPS16 >> 2)
1143                            | ~(elfcpp::STO_MIPS_FLAGS >> 2)))
1144                        | (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_PLT >> 2));
1145
1146     else
1147       // (st_other & ~STO_MIPS_FLAGS) | STO_MIPS_PLT
1148       this->set_nonvis((this->nonvis() & ~(elfcpp::STO_MIPS_FLAGS >> 2))
1149                        | (elfcpp::STO_MIPS_PLT >> 2));
1150   }
1151
1152   // Downcast a base pointer to a Mips_symbol pointer.
1153   static Mips_symbol<size>*
1154   as_mips_sym(Symbol* sym)
1155   { return static_cast<Mips_symbol<size>*>(sym); }
1156
1157   // Downcast a base pointer to a Mips_symbol pointer.
1158   static const Mips_symbol<size>*
1159   as_mips_sym(const Symbol* sym)
1160   { return static_cast<const Mips_symbol<size>*>(sym); }
1161
1162   // Return whether the symbol has lazy-binding stub.
1163   bool
1164   has_lazy_stub() const
1165   { return this->has_lazy_stub_; }
1166
1167   // Set whether the symbol has lazy-binding stub.
1168   void
1169   set_has_lazy_stub(bool has_lazy_stub)
1170   { this->has_lazy_stub_ = has_lazy_stub; }
1171
1172   // Return whether the symbol needs a standard PLT entry.
1173   bool
1174   needs_mips_plt() const
1175   { return this->needs_mips_plt_; }
1176
1177   // Set whether the symbol needs a standard PLT entry.
1178   void
1179   set_needs_mips_plt(bool needs_mips_plt)
1180   { this->needs_mips_plt_ = needs_mips_plt; }
1181
1182   // Return whether the symbol needs a compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT
1183   // entry.
1184   bool
1185   needs_comp_plt() const
1186   { return this->needs_comp_plt_; }
1187
1188   // Set whether the symbol needs a compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry.
1189   void
1190   set_needs_comp_plt(bool needs_comp_plt)
1191   { this->needs_comp_plt_ = needs_comp_plt; }
1192
1193   // Return standard PLT entry offset, or -1 if none.
1194   unsigned int
1195   mips_plt_offset() const
1196   { return this->mips_plt_offset_; }
1197
1198   // Set standard PLT entry offset.
1199   void
1200   set_mips_plt_offset(unsigned int mips_plt_offset)
1201   { this->mips_plt_offset_ = mips_plt_offset; }
1202
1203   // Return whether the symbol has standard PLT entry.
1204   bool
1205   has_mips_plt_offset() const
1206   { return this->mips_plt_offset_ != -1U; }
1207
1208   // Return compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry offset, or -1 if none.
1209   unsigned int
1210   comp_plt_offset() const
1211   { return this->comp_plt_offset_; }
1212
1213   // Set compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry offset.
1214   void
1215   set_comp_plt_offset(unsigned int comp_plt_offset)
1216   { this->comp_plt_offset_ = comp_plt_offset; }
1217
1218   // Return whether the symbol has compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry.
1219   bool
1220   has_comp_plt_offset() const
1221   { return this->comp_plt_offset_ != -1U; }
1222
1223   // Return MIPS16 fn stub for a symbol.
1224   template<bool big_endian>
1225   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1226   get_mips16_fn_stub() const
1227   {
1228     return static_cast<Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(mips16_fn_stub_);
1229   }
1230
1231   // Set MIPS16 fn stub for a symbol.
1232   void
1233   set_mips16_fn_stub(Mips16_stub_section_base* stub)
1234   { this->mips16_fn_stub_ = stub; }
1235
1236   // Return whether symbol has MIPS16 fn stub.
1237   bool
1238   has_mips16_fn_stub() const
1239   { return this->mips16_fn_stub_ != NULL; }
1240
1241   // Return MIPS16 call stub for a symbol.
1242   template<bool big_endian>
1243   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1244   get_mips16_call_stub() const
1245   {
1246     return static_cast<Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(
1247       mips16_call_stub_);
1248   }
1249
1250   // Set MIPS16 call stub for a symbol.
1251   void
1252   set_mips16_call_stub(Mips16_stub_section_base* stub)
1253   { this->mips16_call_stub_ = stub; }
1254
1255   // Return whether symbol has MIPS16 call stub.
1256   bool
1257   has_mips16_call_stub() const
1258   { return this->mips16_call_stub_ != NULL; }
1259
1260   // Return MIPS16 call_fp stub for a symbol.
1261   template<bool big_endian>
1262   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1263   get_mips16_call_fp_stub() const
1264   {
1265     return static_cast<Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(
1266       mips16_call_fp_stub_);
1267   }
1268
1269   // Set MIPS16 call_fp stub for a symbol.
1270   void
1271   set_mips16_call_fp_stub(Mips16_stub_section_base* stub)
1272   { this->mips16_call_fp_stub_ = stub; }
1273
1274   // Return whether symbol has MIPS16 call_fp stub.
1275   bool
1276   has_mips16_call_fp_stub() const
1277   { return this->mips16_call_fp_stub_ != NULL; }
1278
1279   bool
1280   get_applied_secondary_got_fixup() const
1281   { return applied_secondary_got_fixup_; }
1282
1283   void
1284   set_applied_secondary_got_fixup()
1285   { this->applied_secondary_got_fixup_ = true; }
1286
1287  private:
1288   // Whether the symbol needs MIPS16 fn_stub.  This is true if this symbol
1289   // appears in any relocs other than a 16 bit call.
1290   bool need_fn_stub_;
1291
1292   // True if this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
1293   // any non-PIC input file.  This is used to determine whether an
1294   // la25 stub is required.
1295   bool has_nonpic_branches_;
1296
1297   // The offset of the la25 stub for this symbol from the start of the
1298   // la25 stub section.
1299   unsigned int la25_stub_offset_;
1300
1301   // True if there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
1302   // resolved by the static linker (that is, the relocation cannot
1303   // possibly be made dynamic).
1304   bool has_static_relocs_;
1305
1306   // Whether we must not create a lazy-binding stub for this symbol.
1307   // This is true if the symbol has relocations related to taking the
1308   // function's address.
1309   bool no_lazy_stub_;
1310
1311   // The offset of the lazy-binding stub for this symbol from the start of
1312   // .MIPS.stubs section.
1313   unsigned int lazy_stub_offset_;
1314
1315   // True if there are any relocations for this symbol where pointer equality
1316   // matters.
1317   bool pointer_equality_needed_;
1318
1319   // Global GOT area where this symbol in located, or GGA_NONE if symbol is not
1320   // in the global part of the GOT.
1321   Global_got_area global_got_area_;
1322
1323   // The global GOT offset for this symbol.  For multi-GOT links, this is offset
1324   // from the start of .got section to the first GOT entry for the symbol.
1325   // Note that in multi-GOT links the symbol can have entry in more than one GOT.
1326   unsigned int global_gotoffset_;
1327
1328   // Whether all GOT relocations for this symbol are for calls.
1329   bool got_only_for_calls_;
1330   // Whether the symbol has lazy-binding stub.
1331   bool has_lazy_stub_;
1332   // Whether the symbol needs a standard PLT entry.
1333   bool needs_mips_plt_;
1334   // Whether the symbol needs a compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry.
1335   bool needs_comp_plt_;
1336   // Standard PLT entry offset, or -1 if none.
1337   unsigned int mips_plt_offset_;
1338   // Compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry offset, or -1 if none.
1339   unsigned int comp_plt_offset_;
1340   // MIPS16 fn stub for a symbol.
1341   Mips16_stub_section_base* mips16_fn_stub_;
1342   // MIPS16 call stub for a symbol.
1343   Mips16_stub_section_base* mips16_call_stub_;
1344   // MIPS16 call_fp stub for a symbol.
1345   Mips16_stub_section_base* mips16_call_fp_stub_;
1346
1347   bool applied_secondary_got_fixup_;
1348 };
1349
1350 // Mips16_stub_section class.
1351
1352 // The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
1353 // floating point arguments.
1354
1355 // Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
1356 // copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
1357 // then jump to FNNAME.  If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
1358 // call should be redirected to the stub instead.  If no 32 bit
1359 // function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded.  We need to
1360 // consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
1361 // if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
1362 // since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
1363
1364 // Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
1365 // that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
1366 // regs and then jump to FNNAME.  If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
1367 // then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
1368 // to the stub instead.  If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
1369 // stub should be discarded.
1370
1371 // .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
1372 // which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
1373 // to the gp regs.  These stubs store the return address in $18 while
1374 // calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
1375 // must arrange to save $18 around the call.  (This case is not
1376 // needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
1377 // 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
1378 // $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
1379
1380 // Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
1381 // Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally.  Instead, the relocation
1382 // information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
1383
1384 // We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table.
1385
1386 // TODO(sasa): All mips16 stub sections should be emitted in the .text section.
1387
1388 class Mips16_stub_section_base { };
1389
1390 template<int size, bool big_endian>
1391 class Mips16_stub_section : public Mips16_stub_section_base
1392 {
1393   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
1394
1395  public:
1396   Mips16_stub_section(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object, unsigned int shndx)
1397     : object_(object), shndx_(shndx), r_sym_(0), gsym_(NULL),
1398       found_r_mips_none_(false)
1399   {
1400     gold_assert(object->is_mips16_fn_stub_section(shndx)
1401                 || object->is_mips16_call_stub_section(shndx)
1402                 || object->is_mips16_call_fp_stub_section(shndx));
1403   }
1404
1405   // Return the object of this stub section.
1406   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*
1407   object() const
1408   { return this->object_; }
1409
1410   // Return the size of a section.
1411   uint64_t
1412   section_size() const
1413   { return this->object_->section_size(this->shndx_); }
1414
1415   // Return section index of this stub section.
1416   unsigned int
1417   shndx() const
1418   { return this->shndx_; }
1419
1420   // Return symbol index, if stub is for a local function.
1421   unsigned int
1422   r_sym() const
1423   { return this->r_sym_; }
1424
1425   // Return symbol, if stub is for a global function.
1426   Mips_symbol<size>*
1427   gsym() const
1428   { return this->gsym_; }
1429
1430   // Return whether stub is for a local function.
1431   bool
1432   is_for_local_function() const
1433   { return this->gsym_ == NULL; }
1434
1435   // This method is called when a new relocation R_TYPE for local symbol R_SYM
1436   // is found in the stub section.  Try to find stub target.
1437   void
1438   new_local_reloc_found(unsigned int r_type, unsigned int r_sym)
1439   {
1440     // To find target symbol for this stub, trust the first R_MIPS_NONE
1441     // relocation, if any.  Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever
1442     // its kind.
1443     if (this->found_r_mips_none_)
1444       return;
1445     if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE)
1446       {
1447         this->r_sym_ = r_sym;
1448         this->gsym_ = NULL;
1449         this->found_r_mips_none_ = true;
1450       }
1451     else if (!is_target_found())
1452       this->r_sym_ = r_sym;
1453   }
1454
1455   // This method is called when a new relocation R_TYPE for global symbol GSYM
1456   // is found in the stub section.  Try to find stub target.
1457   void
1458   new_global_reloc_found(unsigned int r_type, Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
1459   {
1460     // To find target symbol for this stub, trust the first R_MIPS_NONE
1461     // relocation, if any.  Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever
1462     // its kind.
1463     if (this->found_r_mips_none_)
1464       return;
1465     if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE)
1466       {
1467         this->gsym_ = gsym;
1468         this->r_sym_ = 0;
1469         this->found_r_mips_none_ = true;
1470       }
1471     else if (!is_target_found())
1472       this->gsym_ = gsym;
1473   }
1474
1475   // Return whether we found the stub target.
1476   bool
1477   is_target_found() const
1478   { return this->r_sym_ != 0 || this->gsym_ != NULL;  }
1479
1480   // Return whether this is a fn stub.
1481   bool
1482   is_fn_stub() const
1483   { return this->object_->is_mips16_fn_stub_section(this->shndx_); }
1484
1485   // Return whether this is a call stub.
1486   bool
1487   is_call_stub() const
1488   { return this->object_->is_mips16_call_stub_section(this->shndx_); }
1489
1490   // Return whether this is a call_fp stub.
1491   bool
1492   is_call_fp_stub() const
1493   { return this->object_->is_mips16_call_fp_stub_section(this->shndx_); }
1494
1495   // Return the output address.
1496   Mips_address
1497   output_address() const
1498   {
1499     return (this->object_->output_section(this->shndx_)->address()
1500             + this->object_->output_section_offset(this->shndx_));
1501   }
1502
1503  private:
1504   // The object of this stub section.
1505   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object_;
1506   // The section index of this stub section.
1507   unsigned int shndx_;
1508   // The symbol index, if stub is for a local function.
1509   unsigned int r_sym_;
1510   // The symbol, if stub is for a global function.
1511   Mips_symbol<size>* gsym_;
1512   // True if we found R_MIPS_NONE relocation in this stub.
1513   bool found_r_mips_none_;
1514 };
1515
1516 // Mips_relobj class.
1517
1518 template<int size, bool big_endian>
1519 class Mips_relobj : public Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>
1520 {
1521   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
1522   typedef std::map<unsigned int, Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>
1523     Mips16_stubs_int_map;
1524   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
1525
1526  public:
1527   Mips_relobj(const std::string& name, Input_file* input_file, off_t offset,
1528               const typename elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian>& ehdr)
1529     : Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr),
1530       processor_specific_flags_(0), local_symbol_is_mips16_(),
1531       local_symbol_is_micromips_(), mips16_stub_sections_(),
1532       local_non_16bit_calls_(), local_16bit_calls_(), local_mips16_fn_stubs_(),
1533       local_mips16_call_stubs_(), gp_(0), got_info_(NULL),
1534       section_is_mips16_fn_stub_(), section_is_mips16_call_stub_(),
1535       section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_(), pdr_shndx_(-1U), gprmask_(0),
1536       cprmask1_(0), cprmask2_(0), cprmask3_(0), cprmask4_(0)
1537   {
1538     this->is_pic_ = (ehdr.get_e_flags() & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC) != 0;
1539     this->is_n32_ = elfcpp::abi_n32(ehdr.get_e_flags());
1540   }
1541
1542   ~Mips_relobj()
1543   { }
1544
1545   // Downcast a base pointer to a Mips_relobj pointer.  This is
1546   // not type-safe but we only use Mips_relobj not the base class.
1547   static Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*
1548   as_mips_relobj(Relobj* relobj)
1549   { return static_cast<Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*>(relobj); }
1550
1551   // Downcast a base pointer to a Mips_relobj pointer.  This is
1552   // not type-safe but we only use Mips_relobj not the base class.
1553   static const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*
1554   as_mips_relobj(const Relobj* relobj)
1555   { return static_cast<const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>*>(relobj); }
1556
1557   // Processor-specific flags in ELF file header.  This is valid only after
1558   // reading symbols.
1559   elfcpp::Elf_Word
1560   processor_specific_flags() const
1561   { return this->processor_specific_flags_; }
1562
1563   // Whether a local symbol is MIPS16 symbol.  R_SYM is the symbol table
1564   // index.  This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1565   bool
1566   local_symbol_is_mips16(unsigned int r_sym) const
1567   {
1568     gold_assert(r_sym < this->local_symbol_is_mips16_.size());
1569     return this->local_symbol_is_mips16_[r_sym];
1570   }
1571
1572   // Whether a local symbol is microMIPS symbol.  R_SYM is the symbol table
1573   // index.  This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1574   bool
1575   local_symbol_is_micromips(unsigned int r_sym) const
1576   {
1577     gold_assert(r_sym < this->local_symbol_is_micromips_.size());
1578     return this->local_symbol_is_micromips_[r_sym];
1579   }
1580
1581   // Get or create MIPS16 stub section.
1582   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1583   get_mips16_stub_section(unsigned int shndx)
1584   {
1585     typename Mips16_stubs_int_map::const_iterator it =
1586       this->mips16_stub_sections_.find(shndx);
1587     if (it != this->mips16_stub_sections_.end())
1588       return (*it).second;
1589
1590     Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* stub_section =
1591       new Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>(this, shndx);
1592     this->mips16_stub_sections_.insert(
1593       std::pair<unsigned int, Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(
1594         stub_section->shndx(), stub_section));
1595     return stub_section;
1596   }
1597
1598   // Return MIPS16 fn stub section for local symbol R_SYM, or NULL if this
1599   // object doesn't have fn stub for R_SYM.
1600   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1601   get_local_mips16_fn_stub(unsigned int r_sym) const
1602   {
1603     typename Mips16_stubs_int_map::const_iterator it =
1604       this->local_mips16_fn_stubs_.find(r_sym);
1605     if (it != this->local_mips16_fn_stubs_.end())
1606       return (*it).second;
1607     return NULL;
1608   }
1609
1610   // Record that this object has MIPS16 fn stub for local symbol.  This method
1611   // is only called if we decided not to discard the stub.
1612   void
1613   add_local_mips16_fn_stub(Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* stub)
1614   {
1615     gold_assert(stub->is_for_local_function());
1616     unsigned int r_sym = stub->r_sym();
1617     this->local_mips16_fn_stubs_.insert(
1618       std::pair<unsigned int, Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(
1619         r_sym, stub));
1620   }
1621
1622   // Return MIPS16 call stub section for local symbol R_SYM, or NULL if this
1623   // object doesn't have call stub for R_SYM.
1624   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*
1625   get_local_mips16_call_stub(unsigned int r_sym) const
1626   {
1627     typename Mips16_stubs_int_map::const_iterator it =
1628       this->local_mips16_call_stubs_.find(r_sym);
1629     if (it != this->local_mips16_call_stubs_.end())
1630       return (*it).second;
1631     return NULL;
1632   }
1633
1634   // Record that this object has MIPS16 call stub for local symbol.  This method
1635   // is only called if we decided not to discard the stub.
1636   void
1637   add_local_mips16_call_stub(Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* stub)
1638   {
1639     gold_assert(stub->is_for_local_function());
1640     unsigned int r_sym = stub->r_sym();
1641     this->local_mips16_call_stubs_.insert(
1642       std::pair<unsigned int, Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>*>(
1643         r_sym, stub));
1644   }
1645
1646   // Record that we found "non 16-bit" call relocation against local symbol
1647   // SYMNDX.  This reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 fn stub, if there
1648   // is one.
1649   void
1650   add_local_non_16bit_call(unsigned int symndx)
1651   { this->local_non_16bit_calls_.insert(symndx); }
1652
1653   // Return true if there is any "non 16-bit" call relocation against local
1654   // symbol SYMNDX in this object.
1655   bool
1656   has_local_non_16bit_call_relocs(unsigned int symndx)
1657   {
1658     return (this->local_non_16bit_calls_.find(symndx)
1659             != this->local_non_16bit_calls_.end());
1660   }
1661
1662   // Record that we found 16-bit call relocation R_MIPS16_26 against local
1663   // symbol SYMNDX.  Local MIPS16 call or call_fp stubs will only be needed
1664   // if there is some R_MIPS16_26 relocation that refers to the stub symbol.
1665   void
1666   add_local_16bit_call(unsigned int symndx)
1667   { this->local_16bit_calls_.insert(symndx); }
1668
1669   // Return true if there is any 16-bit call relocation R_MIPS16_26 against local
1670   // symbol SYMNDX in this object.
1671   bool
1672   has_local_16bit_call_relocs(unsigned int symndx)
1673   {
1674     return (this->local_16bit_calls_.find(symndx)
1675             != this->local_16bit_calls_.end());
1676   }
1677
1678   // Get gp value that was used to create this object.
1679   Mips_address
1680   gp_value() const
1681   { return this->gp_; }
1682
1683   // Return whether the object is a PIC object.
1684   bool
1685   is_pic() const
1686   { return this->is_pic_; }
1687
1688   // Return whether the object uses N32 ABI.
1689   bool
1690   is_n32() const
1691   { return this->is_n32_; }
1692
1693   // Return whether the object uses N64 ABI.
1694   bool
1695   is_n64() const
1696   { return size == 64; }
1697
1698   // Return whether the object uses NewABI conventions.
1699   bool
1700   is_newabi() const
1701   { return this->is_n32() || this->is_n64(); }
1702
1703   // Return Mips_got_info for this object.
1704   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>*
1705   get_got_info() const
1706   { return this->got_info_; }
1707
1708   // Return Mips_got_info for this object.  Create new info if it doesn't exist.
1709   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>*
1710   get_or_create_got_info()
1711   {
1712     if (!this->got_info_)
1713       this->got_info_ = new Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>();
1714     return this->got_info_;
1715   }
1716
1717   // Set Mips_got_info for this object.
1718   void
1719   set_got_info(Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* got_info)
1720   { this->got_info_ = got_info; }
1721
1722   // Whether a section SHDNX is a MIPS16 stub section.  This is only valid
1723   // after do_read_symbols is called.
1724   bool
1725   is_mips16_stub_section(unsigned int shndx)
1726   {
1727     return (is_mips16_fn_stub_section(shndx)
1728             || is_mips16_call_stub_section(shndx)
1729             || is_mips16_call_fp_stub_section(shndx));
1730   }
1731
1732   // Return TRUE if relocations in section SHNDX can refer directly to a
1733   // MIPS16 function rather than to a hard-float stub.  This is only valid
1734   // after do_read_symbols is called.
1735   bool
1736   section_allows_mips16_refs(unsigned int shndx)
1737   {
1738     return (this->is_mips16_stub_section(shndx) || shndx == this->pdr_shndx_);
1739   }
1740
1741   // Whether a section SHDNX is a MIPS16 fn stub section.  This is only valid
1742   // after do_read_symbols is called.
1743   bool
1744   is_mips16_fn_stub_section(unsigned int shndx)
1745   {
1746     gold_assert(shndx < this->section_is_mips16_fn_stub_.size());
1747     return this->section_is_mips16_fn_stub_[shndx];
1748   }
1749
1750   // Whether a section SHDNX is a MIPS16 call stub section.  This is only valid
1751   // after do_read_symbols is called.
1752   bool
1753   is_mips16_call_stub_section(unsigned int shndx)
1754   {
1755     gold_assert(shndx < this->section_is_mips16_call_stub_.size());
1756     return this->section_is_mips16_call_stub_[shndx];
1757   }
1758
1759   // Whether a section SHDNX is a MIPS16 call_fp stub section.  This is only
1760   // valid after do_read_symbols is called.
1761   bool
1762   is_mips16_call_fp_stub_section(unsigned int shndx)
1763   {
1764     gold_assert(shndx < this->section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_.size());
1765     return this->section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_[shndx];
1766   }
1767
1768   // Discard MIPS16 stub secions that are not needed.
1769   void
1770   discard_mips16_stub_sections(Symbol_table* symtab);
1771
1772   // Return gprmask from the .reginfo section of this object.
1773   Valtype
1774   gprmask() const
1775   { return this->gprmask_; }
1776
1777   // Return cprmask1 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1778   Valtype
1779   cprmask1() const
1780   { return this->cprmask1_; }
1781
1782   // Return cprmask2 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1783   Valtype
1784   cprmask2() const
1785   { return this->cprmask2_; }
1786
1787   // Return cprmask3 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1788   Valtype
1789   cprmask3() const
1790   { return this->cprmask3_; }
1791
1792   // Return cprmask4 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1793   Valtype
1794   cprmask4() const
1795   { return this->cprmask4_; }
1796
1797  protected:
1798   // Count the local symbols.
1799   void
1800   do_count_local_symbols(Stringpool_template<char>*,
1801                          Stringpool_template<char>*);
1802
1803   // Read the symbol information.
1804   void
1805   do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd);
1806
1807  private:
1808   // The name of the options section.
1809   const char* mips_elf_options_section_name()
1810   { return this->is_newabi() ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options"; }
1811
1812   // processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
1813   elfcpp::Elf_Word processor_specific_flags_;
1814
1815   // Bit vector to tell if a local symbol is a MIPS16 symbol or not.
1816   // This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1817   std::vector<bool> local_symbol_is_mips16_;
1818
1819   // Bit vector to tell if a local symbol is a microMIPS symbol or not.
1820   // This is only valid after do_count_local_symbol is called.
1821   std::vector<bool> local_symbol_is_micromips_;
1822
1823   // Map from section index to the MIPS16 stub for that section.  This contains
1824   // all stubs found in this object.
1825   Mips16_stubs_int_map mips16_stub_sections_;
1826
1827   // Local symbols that have "non 16-bit" call relocation.  This relocation
1828   // would need to refer to a MIPS16 fn stub, if there is one.
1829   std::set<unsigned int> local_non_16bit_calls_;
1830
1831   // Local symbols that have 16-bit call relocation R_MIPS16_26.  Local MIPS16
1832   // call or call_fp stubs will only be needed if there is some R_MIPS16_26
1833   // relocation that refers to the stub symbol.
1834   std::set<unsigned int> local_16bit_calls_;
1835
1836   // Map from local symbol index to the MIPS16 fn stub for that symbol.
1837   // This contains only the stubs that we decided not to discard.
1838   Mips16_stubs_int_map local_mips16_fn_stubs_;
1839
1840   // Map from local symbol index to the MIPS16 call stub for that symbol.
1841   // This contains only the stubs that we decided not to discard.
1842   Mips16_stubs_int_map local_mips16_call_stubs_;
1843
1844   // gp value that was used to create this object.
1845   Mips_address gp_;
1846   // Whether the object is a PIC object.
1847   bool is_pic_ : 1;
1848   // Whether the object uses N32 ABI.
1849   bool is_n32_ : 1;
1850   // The Mips_got_info for this object.
1851   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* got_info_;
1852
1853   // Bit vector to tell if a section is a MIPS16 fn stub section or not.
1854   // This is only valid after do_read_symbols is called.
1855   std::vector<bool> section_is_mips16_fn_stub_;
1856
1857   // Bit vector to tell if a section is a MIPS16 call stub section or not.
1858   // This is only valid after do_read_symbols is called.
1859   std::vector<bool> section_is_mips16_call_stub_;
1860
1861   // Bit vector to tell if a section is a MIPS16 call_fp stub section or not.
1862   // This is only valid after do_read_symbols is called.
1863   std::vector<bool> section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_;
1864
1865   // .pdr section index.
1866   unsigned int pdr_shndx_;
1867
1868   // gprmask from the .reginfo section of this object.
1869   Valtype gprmask_;
1870   // cprmask1 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1871   Valtype cprmask1_;
1872   // cprmask2 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1873   Valtype cprmask2_;
1874   // cprmask3 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1875   Valtype cprmask3_;
1876   // cprmask4 from the .reginfo section of this object.
1877   Valtype cprmask4_;
1878 };
1879
1880 // Mips_output_data_got class.
1881
1882 template<int size, bool big_endian>
1883 class Mips_output_data_got : public Output_data_got<size, big_endian>
1884 {
1885   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
1886   typedef Output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true, size, big_endian>
1887     Reloc_section;
1888   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
1889
1890  public:
1891   Mips_output_data_got(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
1892       Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout)
1893     : Output_data_got<size, big_endian>(), target_(target),
1894       symbol_table_(symtab), layout_(layout), static_relocs_(), got_view_(NULL),
1895       first_global_got_dynsym_index_(-1U), primary_got_(NULL),
1896       secondary_got_relocs_()
1897   {
1898     this->master_got_info_ = new Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>();
1899     this->set_addralign(16);
1900   }
1901
1902   // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against symbol
1903   // SYMNDX + ADDEND, where SYMNDX is a local symbol in section SHNDX in OBJECT.
1904   void
1905   record_local_got_symbol(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
1906                           unsigned int symndx, Mips_address addend,
1907                           unsigned int r_type, unsigned int shndx,
1908                           bool is_section_symbol)
1909   {
1910     this->master_got_info_->record_local_got_symbol(object, symndx, addend,
1911                                                     r_type, shndx,
1912                                                     is_section_symbol);
1913   }
1914
1915   // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against MIPS_SYM,
1916   // in OBJECT.  FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
1917   // using the GOT entry for calls.  DYN_RELOC is true if R_TYPE is a dynamic
1918   // relocation.
1919   void
1920   record_global_got_symbol(Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym,
1921                            Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
1922                            unsigned int r_type, bool dyn_reloc, bool for_call)
1923   {
1924     this->master_got_info_->record_global_got_symbol(mips_sym, object, r_type,
1925                                                      dyn_reloc, for_call);
1926   }
1927
1928   // Record that OBJECT has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
1929   // that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation.
1930   void
1931   record_got_page_entry(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
1932                         unsigned int symndx, int addend)
1933   { this->master_got_info_->record_got_page_entry(object, symndx, addend); }
1934
1935   // Add a static entry for the GOT entry at OFFSET.  GSYM is a global
1936   // symbol and R_TYPE is the code of a dynamic relocation that needs to be
1937   // applied in a static link.
1938   void
1939   add_static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
1940                    Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
1941   { this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, gsym)); }
1942
1943   // Add a static reloc for the GOT entry at OFFSET.  RELOBJ is an object
1944   // defining a local symbol with INDEX.  R_TYPE is the code of a dynamic
1945   // relocation that needs to be applied in a static link.
1946   void
1947   add_static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
1948                    Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* relobj,
1949                    unsigned int index)
1950   {
1951     this->static_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, relobj,
1952                                                 index));
1953   }
1954
1955   // Record that global symbol GSYM has R_TYPE dynamic relocation in the
1956   // secondary GOT at OFFSET.
1957   void
1958   add_secondary_got_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
1959                           Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
1960   {
1961     this->secondary_got_relocs_.push_back(Static_reloc(got_offset,
1962                                                        r_type, gsym));
1963   }
1964
1965   // Update GOT entry at OFFSET with VALUE.
1966   void
1967   update_got_entry(unsigned int offset, Mips_address value)
1968   {
1969     elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(this->got_view_ + offset, value);
1970   }
1971
1972   // Return the number of entries in local part of the GOT.  This includes
1973   // local entries, page entries and 2 reserved entries.
1974   unsigned int
1975   get_local_gotno() const
1976   {
1977     if (!this->multi_got())
1978       {
1979         return (2 + this->master_got_info_->local_gotno()
1980                 + this->master_got_info_->page_gotno());
1981       }
1982     else
1983       return 2 + this->primary_got_->local_gotno() + this->primary_got_->page_gotno();
1984   }
1985
1986   // Return dynamic symbol table index of the first symbol with global GOT
1987   // entry.
1988   unsigned int
1989   first_global_got_dynsym_index() const
1990   { return this->first_global_got_dynsym_index_; }
1991
1992   // Set dynamic symbol table index of the first symbol with global GOT entry.
1993   void
1994   set_first_global_got_dynsym_index(unsigned int index)
1995   { this->first_global_got_dynsym_index_ = index; }
1996
1997   // Lay out the GOT.  Add local, global and TLS entries.  If GOT is
1998   // larger than 64K, create multi-GOT.
1999   void
2000   lay_out_got(Layout* layout, Symbol_table* symtab,
2001               const Input_objects* input_objects);
2002
2003   // Create multi-GOT.  For every GOT, add local, global and TLS entries.
2004   void
2005   lay_out_multi_got(Layout* layout, const Input_objects* input_objects);
2006
2007   // Attempt to merge GOTs of different input objects.
2008   void
2009   merge_gots(const Input_objects* input_objects);
2010
2011   // Consider merging FROM, which is OBJECT's GOT, into TO.  Return false if
2012   // this would lead to overflow, true if they were merged successfully.
2013   bool
2014   merge_got_with(Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from,
2015                  Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
2016                  Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* to);
2017
2018   // Return the offset of GOT page entry for VALUE.  For multi-GOT links,
2019   // use OBJECT's GOT.
2020   unsigned int
2021   get_got_page_offset(Mips_address value,
2022                       const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object)
2023   {
2024     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = (!this->multi_got()
2025                                           ? this->master_got_info_
2026                                           : object->get_got_info());
2027     gold_assert(g != NULL);
2028     return g->get_got_page_offset(value, this);
2029   }
2030
2031   // Return the GOT offset of type GOT_TYPE of the global symbol
2032   // GSYM.  For multi-GOT links, use OBJECT's GOT.
2033   unsigned int got_offset(const Symbol* gsym, unsigned int got_type,
2034                           Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object) const
2035   {
2036     if (!this->multi_got())
2037       return gsym->got_offset(got_type);
2038     else
2039       {
2040         Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = object->get_got_info();
2041         gold_assert(g != NULL);
2042         return gsym->got_offset(g->multigot_got_type(got_type));
2043       }
2044   }
2045
2046   // Return the GOT offset of type GOT_TYPE of the local symbol
2047   // SYMNDX.
2048   unsigned int
2049   got_offset(unsigned int symndx, unsigned int got_type,
2050              Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
2051              uint64_t addend) const
2052   { return object->local_got_offset(symndx, got_type, addend); }
2053
2054   // Return the offset of TLS LDM entry.  For multi-GOT links, use OBJECT's GOT.
2055   unsigned int
2056   tls_ldm_offset(Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object) const
2057   {
2058     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = (!this->multi_got()
2059                                           ? this->master_got_info_
2060                                           : object->get_got_info());
2061     gold_assert(g != NULL);
2062     return g->tls_ldm_offset();
2063   }
2064
2065   // Set the offset of TLS LDM entry.  For multi-GOT links, use OBJECT's GOT.
2066   void
2067   set_tls_ldm_offset(unsigned int tls_ldm_offset,
2068                      Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object)
2069   {
2070     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = (!this->multi_got()
2071                                           ? this->master_got_info_
2072                                           : object->get_got_info());
2073     gold_assert(g != NULL);
2074     g->set_tls_ldm_offset(tls_ldm_offset);
2075   }
2076
2077   // Return true for multi-GOT links.
2078   bool
2079   multi_got() const
2080   { return this->primary_got_ != NULL; }
2081
2082   // Return the offset of OBJECT's GOT from the start of .got section.
2083   unsigned int
2084   get_got_offset(const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object)
2085   {
2086     if (!this->multi_got())
2087       return 0;
2088     else
2089       {
2090         Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = object->get_got_info();
2091         return g != NULL ? g->offset() : 0;
2092       }
2093   }
2094
2095   // Create global GOT entries that should be in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area.
2096   void
2097   add_reloc_only_entries()
2098   { this->master_got_info_->add_reloc_only_entries(this); }
2099
2100   // Return offset of the primary GOT's entry for global symbol.
2101   unsigned int
2102   get_primary_got_offset(const Mips_symbol<size>* sym) const
2103   {
2104     gold_assert(sym->global_got_area() != GGA_NONE);
2105     return (this->get_local_gotno() + sym->dynsym_index()
2106             - this->first_global_got_dynsym_index()) * size/8;
2107   }
2108
2109   // For the entry at offset GOT_OFFSET, return its offset from the gp.
2110   // Input argument GOT_OFFSET is always global offset from the start of
2111   // .got section, for both single and multi-GOT links.
2112   // For single GOT links, this returns GOT_OFFSET - 0x7FF0.  For multi-GOT
2113   // links, the return value is object_got_offset - 0x7FF0, where
2114   // object_got_offset is offset in the OBJECT's GOT.
2115   int
2116   gp_offset(unsigned int got_offset,
2117             const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object) const
2118   {
2119     return (this->address() + got_offset
2120             - this->target_->adjusted_gp_value(object));
2121   }
2122
2123  protected:
2124   // Write out the GOT table.
2125   void
2126   do_write(Output_file*);
2127
2128  private:
2129
2130   // This class represent dynamic relocations that need to be applied by
2131   // gold because we are using TLS relocations in a static link.
2132   class Static_reloc
2133   {
2134    public:
2135     Static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
2136                  Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
2137       : got_offset_(got_offset), r_type_(r_type), symbol_is_global_(true)
2138     { this->u_.global.symbol = gsym; }
2139
2140     Static_reloc(unsigned int got_offset, unsigned int r_type,
2141           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* relobj, unsigned int index)
2142       : got_offset_(got_offset), r_type_(r_type), symbol_is_global_(false)
2143     {
2144       this->u_.local.relobj = relobj;
2145       this->u_.local.index = index;
2146     }
2147
2148     // Return the GOT offset.
2149     unsigned int
2150     got_offset() const
2151     { return this->got_offset_; }
2152
2153     // Relocation type.
2154     unsigned int
2155     r_type() const
2156     { return this->r_type_; }
2157
2158     // Whether the symbol is global or not.
2159     bool
2160     symbol_is_global() const
2161     { return this->symbol_is_global_; }
2162
2163     // For a relocation against a global symbol, the global symbol.
2164     Mips_symbol<size>*
2165     symbol() const
2166     {
2167       gold_assert(this->symbol_is_global_);
2168       return this->u_.global.symbol;
2169     }
2170
2171     // For a relocation against a local symbol, the defining object.
2172     Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*
2173     relobj() const
2174     {
2175       gold_assert(!this->symbol_is_global_);
2176       return this->u_.local.relobj;
2177     }
2178
2179     // For a relocation against a local symbol, the local symbol index.
2180     unsigned int
2181     index() const
2182     {
2183       gold_assert(!this->symbol_is_global_);
2184       return this->u_.local.index;
2185     }
2186
2187    private:
2188     // GOT offset of the entry to which this relocation is applied.
2189     unsigned int got_offset_;
2190     // Type of relocation.
2191     unsigned int r_type_;
2192     // Whether this relocation is against a global symbol.
2193     bool symbol_is_global_;
2194     // A global or local symbol.
2195     union
2196     {
2197       struct
2198       {
2199         // For a global symbol, the symbol itself.
2200         Mips_symbol<size>* symbol;
2201       } global;
2202       struct
2203       {
2204         // For a local symbol, the object defining object.
2205         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* relobj;
2206         // For a local symbol, the symbol index.
2207         unsigned int index;
2208       } local;
2209     } u_;
2210   };
2211
2212   // The target.
2213   Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target_;
2214   // The symbol table.
2215   Symbol_table* symbol_table_;
2216   // The layout.
2217   Layout* layout_;
2218   // Static relocs to be applied to the GOT.
2219   std::vector<Static_reloc> static_relocs_;
2220   // .got section view.
2221   unsigned char* got_view_;
2222   // The dynamic symbol table index of the first symbol with global GOT entry.
2223   unsigned int first_global_got_dynsym_index_;
2224   // The master GOT information.
2225   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* master_got_info_;
2226   // The  primary GOT information.
2227   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* primary_got_;
2228   // Secondary GOT fixups.
2229   std::vector<Static_reloc> secondary_got_relocs_;
2230 };
2231
2232 // A class to handle LA25 stubs - non-PIC interface to a PIC function. There are
2233 // two ways of creating these interfaces.  The first is to add:
2234 //
2235 //      lui     $25,%hi(func)
2236 //      j       func
2237 //      addiu   $25,$25,%lo(func)
2238 //
2239 // to a separate trampoline section.  The second is to add:
2240 //
2241 //      lui     $25,%hi(func)
2242 //      addiu   $25,$25,%lo(func)
2243 //
2244 // immediately before a PIC function "func", but only if a function is at the
2245 // beginning of the section, and the section is not too heavily aligned (i.e we
2246 // would need to add no more than 2 nops before the stub.)
2247 //
2248 // We only create stubs of the first type.
2249
2250 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2251 class Mips_output_data_la25_stub : public Output_section_data
2252 {
2253   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
2254
2255  public:
2256   Mips_output_data_la25_stub()
2257   : Output_section_data(size == 32 ? 4 : 8), symbols_()
2258   { }
2259
2260   // Create LA25 stub for a symbol.
2261   void
2262   create_la25_stub(Symbol_table* symtab, Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
2263                    Mips_symbol<size>* gsym);
2264
2265   // Return output address of a stub.
2266   Mips_address
2267   stub_address(const Mips_symbol<size>* sym) const
2268   {
2269     gold_assert(sym->has_la25_stub());
2270     return this->address() + sym->la25_stub_offset();
2271   }
2272
2273  protected:
2274   void
2275   do_adjust_output_section(Output_section* os)
2276   { os->set_entsize(0); }
2277
2278  private:
2279   // Template for standard LA25 stub.
2280   static const uint32_t la25_stub_entry[];
2281   // Template for microMIPS LA25 stub.
2282   static const uint32_t la25_stub_micromips_entry[];
2283
2284   // Set the final size.
2285   void
2286   set_final_data_size()
2287   { this->set_data_size(this->symbols_.size() * 16); }
2288
2289   // Create a symbol for SYM stub's value and size, to help make the
2290   // disassembly easier to read.
2291   void
2292   create_stub_symbol(Mips_symbol<size>* sym, Symbol_table* symtab,
2293                      Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, uint64_t symsize);
2294
2295   // Write to a map file.
2296   void
2297   do_print_to_mapfile(Mapfile* mapfile) const
2298   { mapfile->print_output_data(this, _(".LA25.stubs")); }
2299
2300   // Write out the LA25 stub section.
2301   void
2302   do_write(Output_file*);
2303
2304   // Symbols that have LA25 stubs.
2305   Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*> symbols_;
2306 };
2307
2308 // MIPS-specific relocation writer.
2309
2310 template<int sh_type, bool dynamic, int size, bool big_endian>
2311 struct Mips_output_reloc_writer;
2312
2313 template<int sh_type, bool dynamic, bool big_endian>
2314 struct Mips_output_reloc_writer<sh_type, dynamic, 32, big_endian>
2315 {
2316   typedef Output_reloc<sh_type, dynamic, 32, big_endian> Output_reloc_type;
2317   typedef std::vector<Output_reloc_type> Relocs;
2318
2319   static void
2320   write(typename Relocs::const_iterator p, unsigned char* pov)
2321   { p->write(pov); }
2322 };
2323
2324 template<int sh_type, bool dynamic, bool big_endian>
2325 struct Mips_output_reloc_writer<sh_type, dynamic, 64, big_endian>
2326 {
2327   typedef Output_reloc<sh_type, dynamic, 64, big_endian> Output_reloc_type;
2328   typedef std::vector<Output_reloc_type> Relocs;
2329
2330   static void
2331   write(typename Relocs::const_iterator p, unsigned char* pov)
2332   {
2333     elfcpp::Mips64_rel_write<big_endian> orel(pov);
2334     orel.put_r_offset(p->get_address());
2335     orel.put_r_sym(p->get_symbol_index());
2336     orel.put_r_ssym(RSS_UNDEF);
2337     orel.put_r_type(p->type());
2338     if (p->type() == elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32)
2339       orel.put_r_type2(elfcpp::R_MIPS_64);
2340     else
2341       orel.put_r_type2(elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE);
2342     orel.put_r_type3(elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE);
2343   }
2344 };
2345
2346 template<int sh_type, bool dynamic, int size, bool big_endian>
2347 class Mips_output_data_reloc : public Output_data_reloc<sh_type, dynamic,
2348                                                         size, big_endian>
2349 {
2350  public:
2351   Mips_output_data_reloc(bool sort_relocs)
2352     : Output_data_reloc<sh_type, dynamic, size, big_endian>(sort_relocs)
2353   { }
2354
2355  protected:
2356   // Write out the data.
2357   void
2358   do_write(Output_file* of)
2359   {
2360     typedef Mips_output_reloc_writer<sh_type, dynamic, size,
2361         big_endian> Writer;
2362     this->template do_write_generic<Writer>(of);
2363   }
2364 };
2365
2366
2367 // A class to handle the PLT data.
2368
2369 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2370 class Mips_output_data_plt : public Output_section_data
2371 {
2372   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
2373   typedef Mips_output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true,
2374                                  size, big_endian> Reloc_section;
2375
2376  public:
2377   // Create the PLT section.  The ordinary .got section is an argument,
2378   // since we need to refer to the start.
2379   Mips_output_data_plt(Layout* layout, Output_data_space* got_plt,
2380                        Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
2381     : Output_section_data(size == 32 ? 4 : 8), got_plt_(got_plt), symbols_(),
2382       plt_mips_offset_(0), plt_comp_offset_(0), plt_header_size_(0),
2383       target_(target)
2384   {
2385     this->rel_ = new Reloc_section(false);
2386     layout->add_output_section_data(".rel.plt", elfcpp::SHT_REL,
2387                                     elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC, this->rel_,
2388                                     ORDER_DYNAMIC_PLT_RELOCS, false);
2389   }
2390
2391   // Add an entry to the PLT for a symbol referenced by r_type relocation.
2392   void
2393   add_entry(Mips_symbol<size>* gsym, unsigned int r_type);
2394
2395   // Return the .rel.plt section data.
2396   const Reloc_section*
2397   rel_plt() const
2398   { return this->rel_; }
2399
2400   // Return the number of PLT entries.
2401   unsigned int
2402   entry_count() const
2403   { return this->symbols_.size(); }
2404
2405   // Return the offset of the first non-reserved PLT entry.
2406   unsigned int
2407   first_plt_entry_offset() const
2408   { return sizeof(plt0_entry_o32); }
2409
2410   // Return the size of a PLT entry.
2411   unsigned int
2412   plt_entry_size() const
2413   { return sizeof(plt_entry); }
2414
2415   // Set final PLT offsets.  For each symbol, determine whether standard or
2416   // compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry is used.
2417   void
2418   set_plt_offsets();
2419
2420   // Return the offset of the first standard PLT entry.
2421   unsigned int
2422   first_mips_plt_offset() const
2423   { return this->plt_header_size_; }
2424
2425   // Return the offset of the first compressed PLT entry.
2426   unsigned int
2427   first_comp_plt_offset() const
2428   { return this->plt_header_size_ + this->plt_mips_offset_; }
2429
2430   // Return whether there are any standard PLT entries.
2431   bool
2432   has_standard_entries() const
2433   { return this->plt_mips_offset_ > 0; }
2434
2435   // Return the output address of standard PLT entry.
2436   Mips_address
2437   mips_entry_address(const Mips_symbol<size>* sym) const
2438   {
2439     gold_assert (sym->has_mips_plt_offset());
2440     return (this->address() + this->first_mips_plt_offset()
2441             + sym->mips_plt_offset());
2442   }
2443
2444   // Return the output address of compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry.
2445   Mips_address
2446   comp_entry_address(const Mips_symbol<size>* sym) const
2447   {
2448     gold_assert (sym->has_comp_plt_offset());
2449     return (this->address() + this->first_comp_plt_offset()
2450             + sym->comp_plt_offset());
2451   }
2452
2453  protected:
2454   void
2455   do_adjust_output_section(Output_section* os)
2456   { os->set_entsize(0); }
2457
2458   // Write to a map file.
2459   void
2460   do_print_to_mapfile(Mapfile* mapfile) const
2461   { mapfile->print_output_data(this, _(".plt")); }
2462
2463  private:
2464   // Template for the first PLT entry.
2465   static const uint32_t plt0_entry_o32[];
2466   static const uint32_t plt0_entry_n32[];
2467   static const uint32_t plt0_entry_n64[];
2468   static const uint32_t plt0_entry_micromips_o32[];
2469   static const uint32_t plt0_entry_micromips32_o32[];
2470
2471   // Template for subsequent PLT entries.
2472   static const uint32_t plt_entry[];
2473   static const uint32_t plt_entry_mips16_o32[];
2474   static const uint32_t plt_entry_micromips_o32[];
2475   static const uint32_t plt_entry_micromips32_o32[];
2476
2477   // Set the final size.
2478   void
2479   set_final_data_size()
2480   {
2481     this->set_data_size(this->plt_header_size_ + this->plt_mips_offset_
2482                         + this->plt_comp_offset_);
2483   }
2484
2485   // Write out the PLT data.
2486   void
2487   do_write(Output_file*);
2488
2489   // Return whether the plt header contains microMIPS code.  For the sake of
2490   // cache alignment always use a standard header whenever any standard entries
2491   // are present even if microMIPS entries are present as well.  This also lets
2492   // the microMIPS header rely on the value of $v0 only set by microMIPS
2493   // entries, for a small size reduction.
2494   bool
2495   is_plt_header_compressed() const
2496   {
2497     gold_assert(this->plt_mips_offset_ + this->plt_comp_offset_ != 0);
2498     return this->target_->is_output_micromips() && this->plt_mips_offset_ == 0;
2499   }
2500
2501   // Return the size of the PLT header.
2502   unsigned int
2503   get_plt_header_size() const
2504   {
2505     if (this->target_->is_output_n64())
2506       return 4 * sizeof(plt0_entry_n64) / sizeof(plt0_entry_n64[0]);
2507     else if (this->target_->is_output_n32())
2508       return 4 * sizeof(plt0_entry_n32) / sizeof(plt0_entry_n32[0]);
2509     else if (!this->is_plt_header_compressed())
2510       return 4 * sizeof(plt0_entry_o32) / sizeof(plt0_entry_o32[0]);
2511     else if (this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
2512       return (2 * sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips32_o32)
2513               / sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips32_o32[0]));
2514     else
2515       return (2 * sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips_o32)
2516               / sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips_o32[0]));
2517   }
2518
2519   // Return the PLT header entry.
2520   const uint32_t*
2521   get_plt_header_entry() const
2522   {
2523     if (this->target_->is_output_n64())
2524       return plt0_entry_n64;
2525     else if (this->target_->is_output_n32())
2526       return plt0_entry_n32;
2527     else if (!this->is_plt_header_compressed())
2528       return plt0_entry_o32;
2529     else if (this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
2530       return plt0_entry_micromips32_o32;
2531     else
2532       return plt0_entry_micromips_o32;
2533   }
2534
2535   // Return the size of the standard PLT entry.
2536   unsigned int
2537   standard_plt_entry_size() const
2538   { return 4 * sizeof(plt_entry) / sizeof(plt_entry[0]); }
2539
2540   // Return the size of the compressed PLT entry.
2541   unsigned int
2542   compressed_plt_entry_size() const
2543   {
2544     gold_assert(!this->target_->is_output_newabi());
2545
2546     if (!this->target_->is_output_micromips())
2547       return (2 * sizeof(plt_entry_mips16_o32)
2548               / sizeof(plt_entry_mips16_o32[0]));
2549     else if (this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
2550       return (2 * sizeof(plt_entry_micromips32_o32)
2551               / sizeof(plt_entry_micromips32_o32[0]));
2552     else
2553       return (2 * sizeof(plt_entry_micromips_o32)
2554               / sizeof(plt_entry_micromips_o32[0]));
2555   }
2556
2557   // The reloc section.
2558   Reloc_section* rel_;
2559   // The .got.plt section.
2560   Output_data_space* got_plt_;
2561   // Symbols that have PLT entry.
2562   std::vector<Mips_symbol<size>*> symbols_;
2563   // The offset of the next standard PLT entry to create.
2564   unsigned int plt_mips_offset_;
2565   // The offset of the next compressed PLT entry to create.
2566   unsigned int plt_comp_offset_;
2567   // The size of the PLT header in bytes.
2568   unsigned int plt_header_size_;
2569   // The target.
2570   Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target_;
2571 };
2572
2573 // A class to handle the .MIPS.stubs data.
2574
2575 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2576 class Mips_output_data_mips_stubs : public Output_section_data
2577 {
2578   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
2579
2580  public:
2581    Mips_output_data_mips_stubs(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
2582      : Output_section_data(size == 32 ? 4 : 8), symbols_(), dynsym_count_(-1U),
2583        stub_offsets_are_set_(false), target_(target)
2584    { }
2585
2586   // Create entry for a symbol.
2587   void
2588   make_entry(Mips_symbol<size>*);
2589
2590   // Remove entry for a symbol.
2591   void
2592   remove_entry(Mips_symbol<size>* gsym);
2593
2594   // Set stub offsets for symbols.  This method expects that the number of
2595   // entries in dynamic symbol table is set.
2596   void
2597   set_lazy_stub_offsets();
2598
2599   void
2600   set_needs_dynsym_value();
2601
2602    // Set the number of entries in dynamic symbol table.
2603   void
2604   set_dynsym_count(unsigned int dynsym_count)
2605   { this->dynsym_count_ = dynsym_count; }
2606
2607   // Return maximum size of the stub, ie. the stub size if the dynamic symbol
2608   // count is greater than 0x10000.  If the dynamic symbol count is less than
2609   // 0x10000, the stub will be 4 bytes smaller.
2610   // There's no disadvantage from using microMIPS code here, so for the sake of
2611   // pure-microMIPS binaries we prefer it whenever there's any microMIPS code in
2612   // output produced at all.  This has a benefit of stubs being shorter by
2613   // 4 bytes each too, unless in the insn32 mode.
2614   unsigned int
2615   stub_max_size() const
2616   {
2617     if (!this->target_->is_output_micromips()
2618         || this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
2619       return 20;
2620     else
2621       return 16;
2622   }
2623
2624   // Return the size of the stub.  This method expects that the final dynsym
2625   // count is set.
2626   unsigned int
2627   stub_size() const
2628   {
2629     gold_assert(this->dynsym_count_ != -1U);
2630     if (this->dynsym_count_ > 0x10000)
2631       return this->stub_max_size();
2632     else
2633       return this->stub_max_size() - 4;
2634   }
2635
2636   // Return output address of a stub.
2637   Mips_address
2638   stub_address(const Mips_symbol<size>* sym) const
2639   {
2640     gold_assert(sym->has_lazy_stub());
2641     return this->address() + sym->lazy_stub_offset();
2642   }
2643
2644  protected:
2645   void
2646   do_adjust_output_section(Output_section* os)
2647   { os->set_entsize(0); }
2648
2649   // Write to a map file.
2650   void
2651   do_print_to_mapfile(Mapfile* mapfile) const
2652   { mapfile->print_output_data(this, _(".MIPS.stubs")); }
2653
2654  private:
2655   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_normal_1[];
2656   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_normal_1_n64[];
2657   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_normal_2[];
2658   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_normal_2_n64[];
2659   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_big[];
2660   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_big_n64[];
2661
2662   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1[];
2663   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1_n64[];
2664   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2[];
2665   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2_n64[];
2666   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_big[];
2667   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips_big_n64[];
2668
2669   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1[];
2670   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1_n64[];
2671   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2[];
2672   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2_n64[];
2673   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_big[];
2674   static const uint32_t lazy_stub_micromips32_big_n64[];
2675
2676   // Set the final size.
2677   void
2678   set_final_data_size()
2679   { this->set_data_size(this->symbols_.size() * this->stub_max_size()); }
2680
2681   // Write out the .MIPS.stubs data.
2682   void
2683   do_write(Output_file*);
2684
2685   // .MIPS.stubs symbols
2686   Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*> symbols_;
2687   // Number of entries in dynamic symbol table.
2688   unsigned int dynsym_count_;
2689   // Whether the stub offsets are set.
2690   bool stub_offsets_are_set_;
2691   // The target.
2692   Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target_;
2693 };
2694
2695 // This class handles Mips .reginfo output section.
2696
2697 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2698 class Mips_output_section_reginfo : public Output_section
2699 {
2700   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
2701
2702  public:
2703   Mips_output_section_reginfo(const char* name, elfcpp::Elf_Word type,
2704                               elfcpp::Elf_Xword flags,
2705                               Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
2706     : Output_section(name, type, flags), target_(target), gprmask_(0),
2707       cprmask1_(0), cprmask2_(0), cprmask3_(0), cprmask4_(0)
2708   { }
2709
2710   // Downcast a base pointer to a Mips_output_section_reginfo pointer.
2711   static Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>*
2712   as_mips_output_section_reginfo(Output_section* os)
2713   { return static_cast<Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>*>(os); }
2714
2715   // Set masks of the output .reginfo section.
2716   void
2717   set_masks(Valtype gprmask, Valtype cprmask1, Valtype cprmask2,
2718             Valtype cprmask3, Valtype cprmask4)
2719   {
2720     this->gprmask_ = gprmask;
2721     this->cprmask1_ = cprmask1;
2722     this->cprmask2_ = cprmask2;
2723     this->cprmask3_ = cprmask3;
2724     this->cprmask4_ = cprmask4;
2725   }
2726
2727  protected:
2728   // Set the final data size.
2729   void
2730   set_final_data_size()
2731   { this->set_data_size(24); }
2732
2733   // Write out reginfo section.
2734   void
2735   do_write(Output_file* of);
2736
2737  private:
2738   Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target_;
2739
2740   // gprmask of the output .reginfo section.
2741   Valtype gprmask_;
2742   // cprmask1 of the output .reginfo section.
2743   Valtype cprmask1_;
2744   // cprmask2 of the output .reginfo section.
2745   Valtype cprmask2_;
2746   // cprmask3 of the output .reginfo section.
2747   Valtype cprmask3_;
2748   // cprmask4 of the output .reginfo section.
2749   Valtype cprmask4_;
2750 };
2751
2752 // The MIPS target has relocation types which default handling of relocatable
2753 // relocation cannot process.  So we have to extend the default code.
2754
2755 template<bool big_endian, typename Classify_reloc>
2756 class Mips_scan_relocatable_relocs :
2757   public Default_scan_relocatable_relocs<Classify_reloc>
2758 {
2759  public:
2760   // Return the strategy to use for a local symbol which is a section
2761   // symbol, given the relocation type.
2762   inline Relocatable_relocs::Reloc_strategy
2763   local_section_strategy(unsigned int r_type, Relobj* object)
2764   {
2765     if (Classify_reloc::sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
2766       return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_ADJUST_FOR_SECTION_RELA;
2767     else
2768       {
2769         switch (r_type)
2770           {
2771           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
2772             return Relocatable_relocs::RELOC_SPECIAL;
2773
2774           default:
2775             return Default_scan_relocatable_relocs<Classify_reloc>::
2776                 local_section_strategy(r_type, object);
2777           }
2778       }
2779   }
2780 };
2781
2782 // Mips_copy_relocs class.  The only difference from the base class is the
2783 // method emit_mips, which should be called instead of Copy_reloc_entry::emit.
2784 // Mips cannot convert all relocation types to dynamic relocs.  If a reloc
2785 // cannot be made dynamic, a COPY reloc is emitted.
2786
2787 template<int sh_type, int size, bool big_endian>
2788 class Mips_copy_relocs : public Copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>
2789 {
2790  public:
2791   Mips_copy_relocs()
2792     : Copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>(elfcpp::R_MIPS_COPY)
2793   { }
2794
2795   // Emit any saved relocations which turn out to be needed.  This is
2796   // called after all the relocs have been scanned.
2797   void
2798   emit_mips(Output_data_reloc<sh_type, true, size, big_endian>*,
2799             Symbol_table*, Layout*, Target_mips<size, big_endian>*);
2800
2801  private:
2802   typedef typename Copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>::Copy_reloc_entry
2803     Copy_reloc_entry;
2804
2805   // Emit this reloc if appropriate.  This is called after we have
2806   // scanned all the relocations, so we know whether we emitted a
2807   // COPY relocation for SYM_.
2808   void
2809   emit_entry(Copy_reloc_entry& entry,
2810              Output_data_reloc<sh_type, true, size, big_endian>* reloc_section,
2811              Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout,
2812              Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target);
2813 };
2814
2815
2816 // Return true if the symbol SYM should be considered to resolve local
2817 // to the current module, and false otherwise.  The logic is taken from
2818 // GNU ld's method _bfd_elf_symbol_refs_local_p.
2819 static bool
2820 symbol_refs_local(const Symbol* sym, bool has_dynsym_entry,
2821                   bool local_protected)
2822 {
2823   // If it's a local sym, of course we resolve locally.
2824   if (sym == NULL)
2825     return true;
2826
2827   // STV_HIDDEN or STV_INTERNAL ones must be local.
2828   if (sym->visibility() == elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN
2829       || sym->visibility() == elfcpp::STV_INTERNAL)
2830     return true;
2831
2832   // If we don't have a definition in a regular file, then we can't
2833   // resolve locally.  The sym is either undefined or dynamic.
2834   if (sym->source() != Symbol::FROM_OBJECT || sym->object()->is_dynamic()
2835       || sym->is_undefined())
2836     return false;
2837
2838   // Forced local symbols resolve locally.
2839   if (sym->is_forced_local())
2840     return true;
2841
2842   // As do non-dynamic symbols.
2843   if (!has_dynsym_entry)
2844     return true;
2845
2846   // At this point, we know the symbol is defined and dynamic.  In an
2847   // executable it must resolve locally, likewise when building symbolic
2848   // shared libraries.
2849   if (parameters->options().output_is_executable()
2850       || parameters->options().Bsymbolic())
2851     return true;
2852
2853   // Now deal with defined dynamic symbols in shared libraries.  Ones
2854   // with default visibility might not resolve locally.
2855   if (sym->visibility() == elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT)
2856     return false;
2857
2858   // STV_PROTECTED non-function symbols are local.
2859   if (sym->type() != elfcpp::STT_FUNC)
2860     return true;
2861
2862   // Function pointer equality tests may require that STV_PROTECTED
2863   // symbols be treated as dynamic symbols.  If the address of a
2864   // function not defined in an executable is set to that function's
2865   // plt entry in the executable, then the address of the function in
2866   // a shared library must also be the plt entry in the executable.
2867   return local_protected;
2868 }
2869
2870 // Return TRUE if references to this symbol always reference the symbol in this
2871 // object.
2872 static bool
2873 symbol_references_local(const Symbol* sym, bool has_dynsym_entry)
2874 {
2875   return symbol_refs_local(sym, has_dynsym_entry, false);
2876 }
2877
2878 // Return TRUE if calls to this symbol always call the version in this object.
2879 static bool
2880 symbol_calls_local(const Symbol* sym, bool has_dynsym_entry)
2881 {
2882   return symbol_refs_local(sym, has_dynsym_entry, true);
2883 }
2884
2885 // Compare GOT offsets of two symbols.
2886
2887 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2888 static bool
2889 got_offset_compare(Symbol* sym1, Symbol* sym2)
2890 {
2891   Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym1 = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(sym1);
2892   Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym2 = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(sym2);
2893   unsigned int area1 = mips_sym1->global_got_area();
2894   unsigned int area2 = mips_sym2->global_got_area();
2895   gold_assert(area1 != GGA_NONE && area1 != GGA_NONE);
2896
2897   // GGA_NORMAL entries always come before GGA_RELOC_ONLY.
2898   if (area1 != area2)
2899     return area1 < area2;
2900
2901   return mips_sym1->global_gotoffset() < mips_sym2->global_gotoffset();
2902 }
2903
2904 // This method divides dynamic symbols into symbols that have GOT entry, and
2905 // symbols that don't have GOT entry.  It also sorts symbols with the GOT entry.
2906 // Mips ABI requires that symbols with the GOT entry must be at the end of
2907 // dynamic symbol table, and the order in dynamic symbol table must match the
2908 // order in GOT.
2909
2910 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2911 static void
2912 reorder_dyn_symbols(std::vector<Symbol*>* dyn_symbols,
2913                     std::vector<Symbol*>* non_got_symbols,
2914                     std::vector<Symbol*>* got_symbols)
2915 {
2916   for (std::vector<Symbol*>::iterator p = dyn_symbols->begin();
2917        p != dyn_symbols->end();
2918        ++p)
2919     {
2920       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(*p);
2921       if (mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_NORMAL
2922           || mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
2923         got_symbols->push_back(mips_sym);
2924       else
2925         non_got_symbols->push_back(mips_sym);
2926     }
2927
2928   std::sort(got_symbols->begin(), got_symbols->end(),
2929             got_offset_compare<size, big_endian>);
2930 }
2931
2932 // Functor class for processing the global symbol table.
2933
2934 template<int size, bool big_endian>
2935 class Symbol_visitor_check_symbols
2936 {
2937  public:
2938   Symbol_visitor_check_symbols(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
2939     Layout* layout, Symbol_table* symtab)
2940     : target_(target), layout_(layout), symtab_(symtab)
2941   { }
2942
2943   void
2944   operator()(Sized_symbol<size>* sym)
2945   {
2946     Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(sym);
2947     if (local_pic_function<size, big_endian>(mips_sym))
2948       {
2949         // SYM is a function that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
2950         // If we're creating a non-PIC relocatable object, mark SYM as
2951         // being PIC.  If we're creating a non-relocatable object with
2952         // non-PIC branches and jumps to SYM, make sure that SYM has an la25
2953         // stub.
2954         if (parameters->options().relocatable())
2955           {
2956             if (!parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
2957               mips_sym->set_pic();
2958           }
2959         else if (mips_sym->has_nonpic_branches())
2960           {
2961             this->target_->la25_stub_section(layout_)
2962                 ->create_la25_stub(this->symtab_, this->target_, mips_sym);
2963           }
2964       }
2965   }
2966
2967  private:
2968   Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target_;
2969   Layout* layout_;
2970   Symbol_table* symtab_;
2971 };
2972
2973 // Relocation types, parameterized by SHT_REL vs. SHT_RELA, size,
2974 // and endianness. The relocation format for MIPS-64 is non-standard.
2975
2976 template<int sh_type, int size, bool big_endian>
2977 struct Mips_reloc_types;
2978
2979 template<bool big_endian>
2980 struct Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 32, big_endian>
2981 {
2982   typedef typename elfcpp::Rel<32, big_endian> Reloc;
2983   typedef typename elfcpp::Rel_write<32, big_endian> Reloc_write;
2984
2985   static typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
2986   get_r_addend(const Reloc*)
2987   { return 0; }
2988
2989   static inline void
2990   set_reloc_addend(Reloc_write*,
2991                    typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword)
2992   { gold_unreachable(); }
2993 };
2994
2995 template<bool big_endian>
2996 struct Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, 32, big_endian>
2997 {
2998   typedef typename elfcpp::Rela<32, big_endian> Reloc;
2999   typedef typename elfcpp::Rela_write<32, big_endian> Reloc_write;
3000
3001   static typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword
3002   get_r_addend(const Reloc* reloc)
3003   { return reloc->get_r_addend(); }
3004
3005   static inline void
3006   set_reloc_addend(Reloc_write* p,
3007                    typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword val)
3008   { p->put_r_addend(val); }
3009 };
3010
3011 template<bool big_endian>
3012 struct Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, 64, big_endian>
3013 {
3014   typedef typename elfcpp::Mips64_rel<big_endian> Reloc;
3015   typedef typename elfcpp::Mips64_rel_write<big_endian> Reloc_write;
3016
3017   static typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword
3018   get_r_addend(const Reloc*)
3019   { return 0; }
3020
3021   static inline void
3022   set_reloc_addend(Reloc_write*,
3023                    typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword)
3024   { gold_unreachable(); }
3025 };
3026
3027 template<bool big_endian>
3028 struct Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, 64, big_endian>
3029 {
3030   typedef typename elfcpp::Mips64_rela<big_endian> Reloc;
3031   typedef typename elfcpp::Mips64_rela_write<big_endian> Reloc_write;
3032
3033   static typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword
3034   get_r_addend(const Reloc* reloc)
3035   { return reloc->get_r_addend(); }
3036
3037   static inline void
3038   set_reloc_addend(Reloc_write* p,
3039                    typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword val)
3040   { p->put_r_addend(val); }
3041 };
3042
3043 // Forward declaration.
3044 static unsigned int
3045 mips_get_size_for_reloc(unsigned int, Relobj*);
3046
3047 // A class for inquiring about properties of a relocation,
3048 // used while scanning relocs during a relocatable link and
3049 // garbage collection.
3050
3051 template<int sh_type_, int size, bool big_endian>
3052 class Mips_classify_reloc;
3053
3054 template<int sh_type_, bool big_endian>
3055 class Mips_classify_reloc<sh_type_, 32, big_endian> :
3056     public gold::Default_classify_reloc<sh_type_, 32, big_endian>
3057 {
3058  public:
3059   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 32, big_endian>::Reloc
3060       Reltype;
3061   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 32, big_endian>::Reloc_write
3062       Reltype_write;
3063
3064   // Return the symbol referred to by the relocation.
3065   static inline unsigned int
3066   get_r_sym(const Reltype* reloc)
3067   { return elfcpp::elf_r_sym<32>(reloc->get_r_info()); }
3068
3069   // Return the type of the relocation.
3070   static inline unsigned int
3071   get_r_type(const Reltype* reloc)
3072   { return elfcpp::elf_r_type<32>(reloc->get_r_info()); }
3073
3074   static inline unsigned int
3075   get_r_type2(const Reltype*)
3076   { return 0; }
3077
3078   static inline unsigned int
3079   get_r_type3(const Reltype*)
3080   { return 0; }
3081
3082   static inline unsigned int
3083   get_r_ssym(const Reltype*)
3084   { return 0; }
3085
3086   // Return the explicit addend of the relocation (return 0 for SHT_REL).
3087   static inline unsigned int
3088   get_r_addend(const Reltype* reloc)
3089   {
3090     if (sh_type_ == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
3091       return 0;
3092     return Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 32, big_endian>::get_r_addend(reloc);
3093   }
3094
3095   // Write the r_info field to a new reloc, using the r_info field from
3096   // the original reloc, replacing the r_sym field with R_SYM.
3097   static inline void
3098   put_r_info(Reltype_write* new_reloc, Reltype* reloc, unsigned int r_sym)
3099   {
3100     unsigned int r_type = elfcpp::elf_r_type<32>(reloc->get_r_info());
3101     new_reloc->put_r_info(elfcpp::elf_r_info<32>(r_sym, r_type));
3102   }
3103
3104   // Write the r_addend field to a new reloc.
3105   static inline void
3106   put_r_addend(Reltype_write* to,
3107                typename elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_Swxword addend)
3108   { Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 32, big_endian>::set_reloc_addend(to, addend); }
3109
3110   // Return the size of the addend of the relocation (only used for SHT_REL).
3111   static unsigned int
3112   get_size_for_reloc(unsigned int r_type, Relobj* obj)
3113   { return mips_get_size_for_reloc(r_type, obj); }
3114 };
3115
3116 template<int sh_type_, bool big_endian>
3117 class Mips_classify_reloc<sh_type_, 64, big_endian> :
3118     public gold::Default_classify_reloc<sh_type_, 64, big_endian>
3119 {
3120  public:
3121   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 64, big_endian>::Reloc
3122       Reltype;
3123   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 64, big_endian>::Reloc_write
3124       Reltype_write;
3125
3126   // Return the symbol referred to by the relocation.
3127   static inline unsigned int
3128   get_r_sym(const Reltype* reloc)
3129   { return reloc->get_r_sym(); }
3130
3131   // Return the r_type of the relocation.
3132   static inline unsigned int
3133   get_r_type(const Reltype* reloc)
3134   { return reloc->get_r_type(); }
3135
3136   // Return the r_type2 of the relocation.
3137   static inline unsigned int
3138   get_r_type2(const Reltype* reloc)
3139   { return reloc->get_r_type2(); }
3140
3141   // Return the r_type3 of the relocation.
3142   static inline unsigned int
3143   get_r_type3(const Reltype* reloc)
3144   { return reloc->get_r_type3(); }
3145
3146   // Return the special symbol of the relocation.
3147   static inline unsigned int
3148   get_r_ssym(const Reltype* reloc)
3149   { return reloc->get_r_ssym(); }
3150
3151   // Return the explicit addend of the relocation (return 0 for SHT_REL).
3152   static inline typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword
3153   get_r_addend(const Reltype* reloc)
3154   {
3155     if (sh_type_ == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
3156       return 0;
3157     return Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 64, big_endian>::get_r_addend(reloc);
3158   }
3159
3160   // Write the r_info field to a new reloc, using the r_info field from
3161   // the original reloc, replacing the r_sym field with R_SYM.
3162   static inline void
3163   put_r_info(Reltype_write* new_reloc, Reltype* reloc, unsigned int r_sym)
3164   {
3165     new_reloc->put_r_sym(r_sym);
3166     new_reloc->put_r_ssym(reloc->get_r_ssym());
3167     new_reloc->put_r_type3(reloc->get_r_type3());
3168     new_reloc->put_r_type2(reloc->get_r_type2());
3169     new_reloc->put_r_type(reloc->get_r_type());
3170   }
3171
3172   // Write the r_addend field to a new reloc.
3173   static inline void
3174   put_r_addend(Reltype_write* to,
3175                typename elfcpp::Elf_types<64>::Elf_Swxword addend)
3176   { Mips_reloc_types<sh_type_, 64, big_endian>::set_reloc_addend(to, addend); }
3177
3178   // Return the size of the addend of the relocation (only used for SHT_REL).
3179   static unsigned int
3180   get_size_for_reloc(unsigned int r_type, Relobj* obj)
3181   { return mips_get_size_for_reloc(r_type, obj); }
3182 };
3183
3184 template<int size, bool big_endian>
3185 class Target_mips : public Sized_target<size, big_endian>
3186 {
3187   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
3188   typedef Mips_output_data_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, true, size, big_endian>
3189     Reloc_section;
3190   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype32;
3191   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
3192   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::Reloc
3193       Reltype;
3194   typedef typename Mips_reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::Reloc
3195       Relatype;
3196
3197  public:
3198   Target_mips(const Target::Target_info* info = &mips_info)
3199     : Sized_target<size, big_endian>(info), got_(NULL), gp_(NULL), plt_(NULL),
3200       got_plt_(NULL), rel_dyn_(NULL), copy_relocs_(),
3201       dyn_relocs_(), la25_stub_(NULL), mips_mach_extensions_(),
3202       mips_stubs_(NULL), mach_(0), layout_(NULL), got16_addends_(),
3203       entry_symbol_is_compressed_(false), insn32_(false)
3204   {
3205     this->add_machine_extensions();
3206   }
3207
3208   // The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section.
3209   static const unsigned int MIPS_GP_OFFSET = 0x7ff0;
3210
3211   // The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
3212   // offsets from $gp.
3213   static const unsigned int MIPS_GOT_MAX_SIZE = MIPS_GP_OFFSET + 0x7fff;
3214
3215   // Make a new symbol table entry for the Mips target.
3216   Sized_symbol<size>*
3217   make_symbol(const char*, elfcpp::STT, Object*, unsigned int, uint64_t)
3218   { return new Mips_symbol<size>(); }
3219
3220   // Process the relocations to determine unreferenced sections for
3221   // garbage collection.
3222   void
3223   gc_process_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
3224                     Layout* layout,
3225                     Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3226                     unsigned int data_shndx,
3227                     unsigned int sh_type,
3228                     const unsigned char* prelocs,
3229                     size_t reloc_count,
3230                     Output_section* output_section,
3231                     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
3232                     size_t local_symbol_count,
3233                     const unsigned char* plocal_symbols);
3234
3235   // Scan the relocations to look for symbol adjustments.
3236   void
3237   scan_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
3238               Layout* layout,
3239               Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3240               unsigned int data_shndx,
3241               unsigned int sh_type,
3242               const unsigned char* prelocs,
3243               size_t reloc_count,
3244               Output_section* output_section,
3245               bool needs_special_offset_handling,
3246               size_t local_symbol_count,
3247               const unsigned char* plocal_symbols);
3248
3249   // Finalize the sections.
3250   void
3251   do_finalize_sections(Layout*, const Input_objects*, Symbol_table*);
3252
3253   // Relocate a section.
3254   void
3255   relocate_section(const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>*,
3256                    unsigned int sh_type,
3257                    const unsigned char* prelocs,
3258                    size_t reloc_count,
3259                    Output_section* output_section,
3260                    bool needs_special_offset_handling,
3261                    unsigned char* view,
3262                    Mips_address view_address,
3263                    section_size_type view_size,
3264                    const Reloc_symbol_changes*);
3265
3266   // Scan the relocs during a relocatable link.
3267   void
3268   scan_relocatable_relocs(Symbol_table* symtab,
3269                           Layout* layout,
3270                           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3271                           unsigned int data_shndx,
3272                           unsigned int sh_type,
3273                           const unsigned char* prelocs,
3274                           size_t reloc_count,
3275                           Output_section* output_section,
3276                           bool needs_special_offset_handling,
3277                           size_t local_symbol_count,
3278                           const unsigned char* plocal_symbols,
3279                           Relocatable_relocs*);
3280
3281   // Scan the relocs for --emit-relocs.
3282   void
3283   emit_relocs_scan(Symbol_table* symtab,
3284                    Layout* layout,
3285                    Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3286                    unsigned int data_shndx,
3287                    unsigned int sh_type,
3288                    const unsigned char* prelocs,
3289                    size_t reloc_count,
3290                    Output_section* output_section,
3291                    bool needs_special_offset_handling,
3292                    size_t local_symbol_count,
3293                    const unsigned char* plocal_syms,
3294                    Relocatable_relocs* rr);
3295
3296   // Emit relocations for a section.
3297   void
3298   relocate_relocs(const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>*,
3299                   unsigned int sh_type,
3300                   const unsigned char* prelocs,
3301                   size_t reloc_count,
3302                   Output_section* output_section,
3303                   typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Off
3304                     offset_in_output_section,
3305                   unsigned char* view,
3306                   Mips_address view_address,
3307                   section_size_type view_size,
3308                   unsigned char* reloc_view,
3309                   section_size_type reloc_view_size);
3310
3311   // Perform target-specific processing in a relocatable link.  This is
3312   // only used if we use the relocation strategy RELOC_SPECIAL.
3313   void
3314   relocate_special_relocatable(const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>* relinfo,
3315                                unsigned int sh_type,
3316                                const unsigned char* preloc_in,
3317                                size_t relnum,
3318                                Output_section* output_section,
3319                                typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Off
3320                                  offset_in_output_section,
3321                                unsigned char* view,
3322                                Mips_address view_address,
3323                                section_size_type view_size,
3324                                unsigned char* preloc_out);
3325
3326   // Return whether SYM is defined by the ABI.
3327   bool
3328   do_is_defined_by_abi(const Symbol* sym) const
3329   {
3330     return ((strcmp(sym->name(), "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
3331             || (strcmp(sym->name(), "_gp_disp") == 0)
3332             || (strcmp(sym->name(), "___tls_get_addr") == 0));
3333   }
3334
3335   // Return the number of entries in the GOT.
3336   unsigned int
3337   got_entry_count() const
3338   {
3339     if (!this->has_got_section())
3340       return 0;
3341     return this->got_size() / (size/8);
3342   }
3343
3344   // Return the number of entries in the PLT.
3345   unsigned int
3346   plt_entry_count() const
3347   {
3348     if (this->plt_ == NULL)
3349       return 0;
3350     return this->plt_->entry_count();
3351   }
3352
3353   // Return the offset of the first non-reserved PLT entry.
3354   unsigned int
3355   first_plt_entry_offset() const
3356   { return this->plt_->first_plt_entry_offset(); }
3357
3358   // Return the size of each PLT entry.
3359   unsigned int
3360   plt_entry_size() const
3361   { return this->plt_->plt_entry_size(); }
3362
3363   // Get the GOT section, creating it if necessary.
3364   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>*
3365   got_section(Symbol_table*, Layout*);
3366
3367   // Get the GOT section.
3368   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>*
3369   got_section() const
3370   {
3371     gold_assert(this->got_ != NULL);
3372     return this->got_;
3373   }
3374
3375   // Get the .MIPS.stubs section, creating it if necessary.
3376   Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>*
3377   mips_stubs_section(Layout* layout);
3378
3379   // Get the .MIPS.stubs section.
3380   Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>*
3381   mips_stubs_section() const
3382   {
3383     gold_assert(this->mips_stubs_ != NULL);
3384     return this->mips_stubs_;
3385   }
3386
3387   // Get the LA25 stub section, creating it if necessary.
3388   Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>*
3389   la25_stub_section(Layout*);
3390
3391   // Get the LA25 stub section.
3392   Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>*
3393   la25_stub_section()
3394   {
3395     gold_assert(this->la25_stub_ != NULL);
3396     return this->la25_stub_;
3397   }
3398
3399   // Get gp value.  It has the value of .got + 0x7FF0.
3400   Mips_address
3401   gp_value() const
3402   {
3403     if (this->gp_ != NULL)
3404       return this->gp_->value();
3405     return 0;
3406   }
3407
3408   // Get gp value.  It has the value of .got + 0x7FF0.  Adjust it for
3409   // multi-GOT links so that OBJECT's GOT + 0x7FF0 is returned.
3410   Mips_address
3411   adjusted_gp_value(const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object)
3412   {
3413     if (this->gp_ == NULL)
3414       return 0;
3415
3416     bool multi_got = false;
3417     if (this->has_got_section())
3418       multi_got = this->got_section()->multi_got();
3419     if (!multi_got)
3420       return this->gp_->value();
3421     else
3422       return this->gp_->value() + this->got_section()->get_got_offset(object);
3423   }
3424
3425   // Get the dynamic reloc section, creating it if necessary.
3426   Reloc_section*
3427   rel_dyn_section(Layout*);
3428
3429   bool
3430   do_has_custom_set_dynsym_indexes() const
3431   { return true; }
3432
3433   // Don't emit input .reginfo sections to output .reginfo.
3434   bool
3435   do_should_include_section(elfcpp::Elf_Word sh_type) const
3436   { return sh_type != elfcpp::SHT_MIPS_REGINFO; }
3437
3438   // Set the dynamic symbol indexes.  INDEX is the index of the first
3439   // global dynamic symbol.  Pointers to the symbols are stored into the
3440   // vector SYMS.  The names are added to DYNPOOL.  This returns an
3441   // updated dynamic symbol index.
3442   unsigned int
3443   do_set_dynsym_indexes(std::vector<Symbol*>* dyn_symbols, unsigned int index,
3444                         std::vector<Symbol*>* syms, Stringpool* dynpool,
3445                         Versions* versions, Symbol_table* symtab) const;
3446
3447   // Remove .MIPS.stubs entry for a symbol.
3448   void
3449   remove_lazy_stub_entry(Mips_symbol<size>* sym)
3450   {
3451     if (this->mips_stubs_ != NULL)
3452       this->mips_stubs_->remove_entry(sym);
3453   }
3454
3455   // The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
3456   // a GNU object.  The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
3457   // module pointer.
3458   uint64_t
3459   mips_elf_gnu_got1_mask()
3460   {
3461     if (this->is_output_n64())
3462       return (uint64_t)1 << 63;
3463     else
3464       return 1 << 31;
3465   }
3466
3467   // Whether the output has microMIPS code.  This is valid only after
3468   // merge_processor_specific_flags() is called.
3469   bool
3470   is_output_micromips() const
3471   {
3472     gold_assert(this->are_processor_specific_flags_set());
3473     return elfcpp::is_micromips(this->processor_specific_flags());
3474   }
3475
3476   // Whether the output uses N32 ABI.  This is valid only after
3477   // merge_processor_specific_flags() is called.
3478   bool
3479   is_output_n32() const
3480   {
3481     gold_assert(this->are_processor_specific_flags_set());
3482     return elfcpp::abi_n32(this->processor_specific_flags());
3483   }
3484
3485   // Whether the output uses N64 ABI.
3486   bool
3487   is_output_n64() const
3488   { return size == 64; }
3489
3490   // Whether the output uses NEWABI.  This is valid only after
3491   // merge_processor_specific_flags() is called.
3492   bool
3493   is_output_newabi() const
3494   { return this->is_output_n32() || this->is_output_n64(); }
3495
3496   // Whether we can only use 32-bit microMIPS instructions.
3497   bool
3498   use_32bit_micromips_instructions() const
3499   { return this->insn32_; }
3500
3501   // Return the r_sym field from a relocation.
3502   unsigned int
3503   get_r_sym(const unsigned char* preloc) const
3504   {
3505     // Since REL and RELA relocs share the same structure through
3506     // the r_info field, we can just use REL here.
3507     Reltype rel(preloc);
3508     return Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::
3509         get_r_sym(&rel);
3510   }
3511
3512  protected:
3513   // Return the value to use for a dynamic symbol which requires special
3514   // treatment.  This is how we support equality comparisons of function
3515   // pointers across shared library boundaries, as described in the
3516   // processor specific ABI supplement.
3517   uint64_t
3518   do_dynsym_value(const Symbol* gsym) const;
3519
3520   // Make an ELF object.
3521   Object*
3522   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
3523                      const elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian>& ehdr);
3524
3525   Object*
3526   do_make_elf_object(const std::string&, Input_file*, off_t,
3527                      const elfcpp::Ehdr<size, !big_endian>&)
3528   { gold_unreachable(); }
3529
3530   // Make an output section.
3531   Output_section*
3532   do_make_output_section(const char* name, elfcpp::Elf_Word type,
3533                          elfcpp::Elf_Xword flags)
3534     {
3535       if (type == elfcpp::SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
3536         return new Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>(name, type,
3537                                                                  flags, this);
3538       else
3539         return new Output_section(name, type, flags);
3540     }
3541
3542   // Adjust ELF file header.
3543   void
3544   do_adjust_elf_header(unsigned char* view, int len);
3545
3546   // Get the custom dynamic tag value.
3547   unsigned int
3548   do_dynamic_tag_custom_value(elfcpp::DT) const;
3549
3550   // Adjust the value written to the dynamic symbol table.
3551   virtual void
3552   do_adjust_dyn_symbol(const Symbol* sym, unsigned char* view) const
3553   {
3554     elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian> isym(view);
3555     elfcpp::Sym_write<size, big_endian> osym(view);
3556     const Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(sym);
3557
3558     // Keep dynamic compressed symbols odd.  This allows the dynamic linker
3559     // to treat compressed symbols like any other.
3560     Mips_address value = isym.get_st_value();
3561     if (mips_sym->is_mips16() && value != 0)
3562       {
3563         if (!mips_sym->has_mips16_fn_stub())
3564           value |= 1;
3565         else
3566           {
3567             // If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol
3568             // must refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard
3569             // calling conventions.  Stub contains MIPS32 code, so don't add +1
3570             // in this case.
3571
3572             // There is a code which does this in the method
3573             // Target_mips::do_dynsym_value, but that code will only be
3574             // executed if the symbol is from dynobj.
3575             // TODO(sasa): GNU ld also changes the value in non-dynamic symbol
3576             // table.
3577
3578             Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* fn_stub =
3579               mips_sym->template get_mips16_fn_stub<big_endian>();
3580             value = fn_stub->output_address();
3581             osym.put_st_size(fn_stub->section_size());
3582           }
3583
3584         osym.put_st_value(value);
3585         osym.put_st_other(elfcpp::elf_st_other(sym->visibility(),
3586                           mips_sym->nonvis() - (elfcpp::STO_MIPS16 >> 2)));
3587       }
3588     else if ((mips_sym->is_micromips()
3589               // Stubs are always microMIPS if there is any microMIPS code in
3590               // the output.
3591               || (this->is_output_micromips() && mips_sym->has_lazy_stub()))
3592              && value != 0)
3593       {
3594         osym.put_st_value(value | 1);
3595         osym.put_st_other(elfcpp::elf_st_other(sym->visibility(),
3596                           mips_sym->nonvis() - (elfcpp::STO_MICROMIPS >> 2)));
3597       }
3598   }
3599
3600  private:
3601   // The class which scans relocations.
3602   class Scan
3603   {
3604    public:
3605     Scan()
3606     { }
3607
3608     static inline int
3609     get_reference_flags(unsigned int r_type);
3610
3611     inline void
3612     local(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3613           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3614           unsigned int data_shndx,
3615           Output_section* output_section,
3616           const Reltype& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
3617           const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
3618           bool is_discarded);
3619
3620     inline void
3621     local(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3622           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3623           unsigned int data_shndx,
3624           Output_section* output_section,
3625           const Relatype& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
3626           const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
3627           bool is_discarded);
3628
3629     inline void
3630     local(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3631           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3632           unsigned int data_shndx,
3633           Output_section* output_section,
3634           const Relatype* rela,
3635           const Reltype* rel,
3636           unsigned int rel_type,
3637           unsigned int r_type,
3638           const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
3639           bool is_discarded);
3640
3641     inline void
3642     global(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3643            Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3644            unsigned int data_shndx,
3645            Output_section* output_section,
3646            const Reltype& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
3647            Symbol* gsym);
3648
3649     inline void
3650     global(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3651            Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3652            unsigned int data_shndx,
3653            Output_section* output_section,
3654            const Relatype& reloc, unsigned int r_type,
3655            Symbol* gsym);
3656
3657     inline void
3658     global(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips* target,
3659            Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3660            unsigned int data_shndx,
3661            Output_section* output_section,
3662            const Relatype* rela,
3663            const Reltype* rel,
3664            unsigned int rel_type,
3665            unsigned int r_type,
3666            Symbol* gsym);
3667
3668     inline bool
3669     local_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table* , Layout*,
3670                                         Target_mips*,
3671                                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3672                                         unsigned int,
3673                                         Output_section*,
3674                                         const Reltype&,
3675                                         unsigned int,
3676                                         const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>&)
3677     { return false; }
3678
3679     inline bool
3680     global_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table*, Layout*,
3681                                          Target_mips*,
3682                                          Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3683                                          unsigned int,
3684                                          Output_section*,
3685                                          const Reltype&,
3686                                          unsigned int, Symbol*)
3687     { return false; }
3688
3689     inline bool
3690     local_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table*, Layout*,
3691                                         Target_mips*,
3692                                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3693                                         unsigned int,
3694                                         Output_section*,
3695                                         const Relatype&,
3696                                         unsigned int,
3697                                         const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>&)
3698     { return false; }
3699
3700     inline bool
3701     global_reloc_may_be_function_pointer(Symbol_table*, Layout*,
3702                                          Target_mips*,
3703                                          Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3704                                          unsigned int,
3705                                          Output_section*,
3706                                          const Relatype&,
3707                                          unsigned int, Symbol*)
3708     { return false; }
3709    private:
3710     static void
3711     unsupported_reloc_local(Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3712                             unsigned int r_type);
3713
3714     static void
3715     unsupported_reloc_global(Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>*,
3716                              unsigned int r_type, Symbol*);
3717   };
3718
3719   // The class which implements relocation.
3720   class Relocate
3721   {
3722    public:
3723     Relocate()
3724     { }
3725
3726     ~Relocate()
3727     { }
3728
3729     // Return whether a R_MIPS_32/R_MIPS_64 relocation needs to be applied.
3730     inline bool
3731     should_apply_static_reloc(const Mips_symbol<size>* gsym,
3732                               unsigned int r_type,
3733                               Output_section* output_section,
3734                               Target_mips* target);
3735
3736     // Do a relocation.  Return false if the caller should not issue
3737     // any warnings about this relocation.
3738     inline bool
3739     relocate(const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>*, unsigned int,
3740              Target_mips*, Output_section*, size_t, const unsigned char*,
3741              const Sized_symbol<size>*, const Symbol_value<size>*,
3742              unsigned char*, Mips_address, section_size_type);
3743   };
3744
3745   // This POD class holds the dynamic relocations that should be emitted instead
3746   // of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32 and R_MIPS_64 relocations.  We will emit these
3747   // relocations if it turns out that the symbol does not have static
3748   // relocations.
3749   class Dyn_reloc
3750   {
3751    public:
3752     Dyn_reloc(Mips_symbol<size>* sym, unsigned int r_type,
3753               Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* relobj, unsigned int shndx,
3754               Output_section* output_section, Mips_address r_offset)
3755       : sym_(sym), r_type_(r_type), relobj_(relobj),
3756         shndx_(shndx), output_section_(output_section),
3757         r_offset_(r_offset)
3758     { }
3759
3760     // Emit this reloc if appropriate.  This is called after we have
3761     // scanned all the relocations, so we know whether the symbol has
3762     // static relocations.
3763     void
3764     emit(Reloc_section* rel_dyn, Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got,
3765          Symbol_table* symtab)
3766     {
3767       if (!this->sym_->has_static_relocs())
3768         {
3769           got->record_global_got_symbol(this->sym_, this->relobj_,
3770                                         this->r_type_, true, false);
3771           if (!symbol_references_local(this->sym_,
3772                                 this->sym_->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab)))
3773             rel_dyn->add_global(this->sym_, this->r_type_,
3774                                 this->output_section_, this->relobj_,
3775                                 this->shndx_, this->r_offset_);
3776           else
3777             rel_dyn->add_symbolless_global_addend(this->sym_, this->r_type_,
3778                                           this->output_section_, this->relobj_,
3779                                           this->shndx_, this->r_offset_);
3780         }
3781     }
3782
3783    private:
3784     Mips_symbol<size>* sym_;
3785     unsigned int r_type_;
3786     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* relobj_;
3787     unsigned int shndx_;
3788     Output_section* output_section_;
3789     Mips_address r_offset_;
3790   };
3791
3792   // Adjust TLS relocation type based on the options and whether this
3793   // is a local symbol.
3794   static tls::Tls_optimization
3795   optimize_tls_reloc(bool is_final, int r_type);
3796
3797   // Return whether there is a GOT section.
3798   bool
3799   has_got_section() const
3800   { return this->got_ != NULL; }
3801
3802   // Check whether the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary.
3803   bool
3804   mips_32bit_flags(elfcpp::Elf_Word);
3805
3806   enum Mips_mach {
3807     mach_mips3000             = 3000,
3808     mach_mips3900             = 3900,
3809     mach_mips4000             = 4000,
3810     mach_mips4010             = 4010,
3811     mach_mips4100             = 4100,
3812     mach_mips4111             = 4111,
3813     mach_mips4120             = 4120,
3814     mach_mips4300             = 4300,
3815     mach_mips4400             = 4400,
3816     mach_mips4600             = 4600,
3817     mach_mips4650             = 4650,
3818     mach_mips5000             = 5000,
3819     mach_mips5400             = 5400,
3820     mach_mips5500             = 5500,
3821     mach_mips6000             = 6000,
3822     mach_mips7000             = 7000,
3823     mach_mips8000             = 8000,
3824     mach_mips9000             = 9000,
3825     mach_mips10000            = 10000,
3826     mach_mips12000            = 12000,
3827     mach_mips14000            = 14000,
3828     mach_mips16000            = 16000,
3829     mach_mips16               = 16,
3830     mach_mips5                = 5,
3831     mach_mips_loongson_2e     = 3001,
3832     mach_mips_loongson_2f     = 3002,
3833     mach_mips_loongson_3a     = 3003,
3834     mach_mips_sb1             = 12310201, // octal 'SB', 01
3835     mach_mips_octeon          = 6501,
3836     mach_mips_octeonp         = 6601,
3837     mach_mips_octeon2         = 6502,
3838     mach_mips_xlr             = 887682,   // decimal 'XLR'
3839     mach_mipsisa32            = 32,
3840     mach_mipsisa32r2          = 33,
3841     mach_mipsisa64            = 64,
3842     mach_mipsisa64r2          = 65,
3843     mach_mips_micromips       = 96
3844   };
3845
3846   // Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value.
3847   unsigned int
3848   elf_mips_mach(elfcpp::Elf_Word);
3849
3850   // Check whether machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE.
3851   bool
3852   mips_mach_extends(unsigned int, unsigned int);
3853
3854   // Merge processor specific flags.
3855   void
3856   merge_processor_specific_flags(const std::string&, elfcpp::Elf_Word, bool);
3857
3858   // True if we are linking for CPUs that are faster if JAL is converted to BAL.
3859   static inline bool
3860   jal_to_bal()
3861   { return false; }
3862
3863   // True if we are linking for CPUs that are faster if JALR is converted to
3864   // BAL.  This should be safe for all architectures.  We enable this predicate
3865   // for all CPUs.
3866   static inline bool
3867   jalr_to_bal()
3868   { return true; }
3869
3870   // True if we are linking for CPUs that are faster if JR is converted to B.
3871   // This should be safe for all architectures.  We enable this predicate for
3872   // all CPUs.
3873   static inline bool
3874   jr_to_b()
3875   { return true; }
3876
3877   // Return the size of the GOT section.
3878   section_size_type
3879   got_size() const
3880   {
3881     gold_assert(this->got_ != NULL);
3882     return this->got_->data_size();
3883   }
3884
3885   // Create a PLT entry for a global symbol referenced by r_type relocation.
3886   void
3887   make_plt_entry(Symbol_table*, Layout*, Mips_symbol<size>*,
3888                  unsigned int r_type);
3889
3890   // Get the PLT section.
3891   Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>*
3892   plt_section() const
3893   {
3894     gold_assert(this->plt_ != NULL);
3895     return this->plt_;
3896   }
3897
3898   // Get the GOT PLT section.
3899   const Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>*
3900   got_plt_section() const
3901   {
3902     gold_assert(this->got_plt_ != NULL);
3903     return this->got_plt_;
3904   }
3905
3906   // Copy a relocation against a global symbol.
3907   void
3908   copy_reloc(Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout,
3909              Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
3910              unsigned int shndx, Output_section* output_section,
3911              Symbol* sym, unsigned int r_type, Mips_address r_offset)
3912   {
3913     this->copy_relocs_.copy_reloc(symtab, layout,
3914                                   symtab->get_sized_symbol<size>(sym),
3915                                   object, shndx, output_section,
3916                                   r_type, r_offset, 0,
3917                                   this->rel_dyn_section(layout));
3918   }
3919
3920   void
3921   dynamic_reloc(Mips_symbol<size>* sym, unsigned int r_type,
3922                 Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* relobj,
3923                 unsigned int shndx, Output_section* output_section,
3924                 Mips_address r_offset)
3925   {
3926     this->dyn_relocs_.push_back(Dyn_reloc(sym, r_type, relobj, shndx,
3927                                           output_section, r_offset));
3928   }
3929
3930   // Calculate value of _gp symbol.
3931   void
3932   set_gp(Layout*, Symbol_table*);
3933
3934   const char*
3935   elf_mips_abi_name(elfcpp::Elf_Word e_flags);
3936   const char*
3937   elf_mips_mach_name(elfcpp::Elf_Word e_flags);
3938
3939   // Adds entries that describe how machines relate to one another.  The entries
3940   // are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last.  First
3941   // element is extension, second element is base.
3942   void
3943   add_machine_extensions()
3944   {
3945     // MIPS64r2 extensions.
3946     this->add_extension(mach_mips_octeon2, mach_mips_octeonp);
3947     this->add_extension(mach_mips_octeonp, mach_mips_octeon);
3948     this->add_extension(mach_mips_octeon, mach_mipsisa64r2);
3949
3950     // MIPS64 extensions.
3951     this->add_extension(mach_mipsisa64r2, mach_mipsisa64);
3952     this->add_extension(mach_mips_sb1, mach_mipsisa64);
3953     this->add_extension(mach_mips_xlr, mach_mipsisa64);
3954     this->add_extension(mach_mips_loongson_3a, mach_mipsisa64);
3955
3956     // MIPS V extensions.
3957     this->add_extension(mach_mipsisa64, mach_mips5);
3958
3959     // R10000 extensions.
3960     this->add_extension(mach_mips12000, mach_mips10000);
3961     this->add_extension(mach_mips14000, mach_mips10000);
3962     this->add_extension(mach_mips16000, mach_mips10000);
3963
3964     // R5000 extensions.  Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
3965     // vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff.  It seems
3966     // better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
3967     // many libraries will just use the core ISA.  Perhaps we could add
3968     // some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem.
3969     this->add_extension(mach_mips5500, mach_mips5400);
3970     this->add_extension(mach_mips5400, mach_mips5000);
3971
3972     // MIPS IV extensions.
3973     this->add_extension(mach_mips5, mach_mips8000);
3974     this->add_extension(mach_mips10000, mach_mips8000);
3975     this->add_extension(mach_mips5000, mach_mips8000);
3976     this->add_extension(mach_mips7000, mach_mips8000);
3977     this->add_extension(mach_mips9000, mach_mips8000);
3978
3979     // VR4100 extensions.
3980     this->add_extension(mach_mips4120, mach_mips4100);
3981     this->add_extension(mach_mips4111, mach_mips4100);
3982
3983     // MIPS III extensions.
3984     this->add_extension(mach_mips_loongson_2e, mach_mips4000);
3985     this->add_extension(mach_mips_loongson_2f, mach_mips4000);
3986     this->add_extension(mach_mips8000, mach_mips4000);
3987     this->add_extension(mach_mips4650, mach_mips4000);
3988     this->add_extension(mach_mips4600, mach_mips4000);
3989     this->add_extension(mach_mips4400, mach_mips4000);
3990     this->add_extension(mach_mips4300, mach_mips4000);
3991     this->add_extension(mach_mips4100, mach_mips4000);
3992     this->add_extension(mach_mips4010, mach_mips4000);
3993
3994     // MIPS32 extensions.
3995     this->add_extension(mach_mipsisa32r2, mach_mipsisa32);
3996
3997     // MIPS II extensions.
3998     this->add_extension(mach_mips4000, mach_mips6000);
3999     this->add_extension(mach_mipsisa32, mach_mips6000);
4000
4001     // MIPS I extensions.
4002     this->add_extension(mach_mips6000, mach_mips3000);
4003     this->add_extension(mach_mips3900, mach_mips3000);
4004   }
4005
4006   // Add value to MIPS extenstions.
4007   void
4008   add_extension(unsigned int base, unsigned int extension)
4009   {
4010     std::pair<unsigned int, unsigned int> ext(base, extension);
4011     this->mips_mach_extensions_.push_back(ext);
4012   }
4013
4014   // Return the number of entries in the .dynsym section.
4015   unsigned int get_dt_mips_symtabno() const
4016   {
4017     return ((unsigned int)(this->layout_->dynsym_section()->data_size()
4018                            / elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::sym_size));
4019     // TODO(sasa): Entry size is MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE.
4020   }
4021
4022   // Information about this specific target which we pass to the
4023   // general Target structure.
4024   static const Target::Target_info mips_info;
4025   // The GOT section.
4026   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got_;
4027   // gp symbol.  It has the value of .got + 0x7FF0.
4028   Sized_symbol<size>* gp_;
4029   // The PLT section.
4030   Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>* plt_;
4031   // The GOT PLT section.
4032   Output_data_space* got_plt_;
4033   // The dynamic reloc section.
4034   Reloc_section* rel_dyn_;
4035   // Relocs saved to avoid a COPY reloc.
4036   Mips_copy_relocs<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian> copy_relocs_;
4037
4038   // A list of dyn relocs to be saved.
4039   std::vector<Dyn_reloc> dyn_relocs_;
4040
4041   // The LA25 stub section.
4042   Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>* la25_stub_;
4043   // Architecture extensions.
4044   std::vector<std::pair<unsigned int, unsigned int> > mips_mach_extensions_;
4045   // .MIPS.stubs
4046   Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>* mips_stubs_;
4047
4048   unsigned int mach_;
4049   Layout* layout_;
4050
4051   typename std::list<got16_addend<size, big_endian> > got16_addends_;
4052
4053   // Whether the entry symbol is mips16 or micromips.
4054   bool entry_symbol_is_compressed_;
4055
4056   // Whether we can use only 32-bit microMIPS instructions.
4057   // TODO(sasa): This should be a linker option.
4058   bool insn32_;
4059 };
4060
4061 // Helper structure for R_MIPS*_HI16/LO16 and R_MIPS*_GOT16/LO16 relocations.
4062 // It records high part of the relocation pair.
4063
4064 template<int size, bool big_endian>
4065 struct reloc_high
4066 {
4067   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
4068
4069   reloc_high(unsigned char* _view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* _object,
4070              const Symbol_value<size>* _psymval, Mips_address _addend,
4071              unsigned int _r_type, unsigned int _r_sym, bool _extract_addend,
4072              Mips_address _address = 0, bool _gp_disp = false)
4073     : view(_view), object(_object), psymval(_psymval), addend(_addend),
4074       r_type(_r_type), r_sym(_r_sym), extract_addend(_extract_addend),
4075       address(_address), gp_disp(_gp_disp)
4076   { }
4077
4078   unsigned char* view;
4079   const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object;
4080   const Symbol_value<size>* psymval;
4081   Mips_address addend;
4082   unsigned int r_type;
4083   unsigned int r_sym;
4084   bool extract_addend;
4085   Mips_address address;
4086   bool gp_disp;
4087 };
4088
4089 template<int size, bool big_endian>
4090 class Mips_relocate_functions : public Relocate_functions<size, big_endian>
4091 {
4092   typedef typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Addr Mips_address;
4093   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype;
4094   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype16;
4095   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype32;
4096   typedef typename elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::Valtype Valtype64;
4097
4098  public:
4099   typedef enum
4100   {
4101     STATUS_OKAY,        // No error during relocation.
4102     STATUS_OVERFLOW,    // Relocation overflow.
4103     STATUS_BAD_RELOC    // Relocation cannot be applied.
4104   } Status;
4105
4106  private:
4107   typedef Relocate_functions<size, big_endian> Base;
4108   typedef Mips_relocate_functions<size, big_endian> This;
4109
4110   static typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> > hi16_relocs;
4111   static typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> > got16_relocs;
4112
4113   template<int valsize>
4114   static inline typename This::Status
4115   check_overflow(Valtype value)
4116   {
4117     if (size == 32)
4118       return (Bits<valsize>::has_overflow32(value)
4119               ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
4120               : This::STATUS_OKAY);
4121
4122     return (Bits<valsize>::has_overflow(value)
4123             ? This::STATUS_OVERFLOW
4124             : This::STATUS_OKAY);
4125   }
4126
4127   static inline bool
4128   should_shuffle_micromips_reloc(unsigned int r_type)
4129   {
4130     return (micromips_reloc(r_type)
4131             && r_type != elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
4132             && r_type != elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
4133   }
4134
4135  public:
4136   //   R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
4137   //   Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
4138   //   are 32 bits.
4139   //
4140   //   The format of these instructions is:
4141   //
4142   //   +--------------+--------------------------------+
4143   //   |     JALX     | X|   Imm 20:16  |   Imm 25:21  |
4144   //   +--------------+--------------------------------+
4145   //   |                Immediate  15:0                |
4146   //   +-----------------------------------------------+
4147   //
4148   //   JALX is the 5-bit value 00011.  X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
4149   //   Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
4150   //
4151   //   When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
4152   //   handled mostly like R_MIPS_26.  In particular, the addend is
4153   //   stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
4154   //   (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
4155   //   R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
4156   //   always zero).  However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
4157   //   16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value.  In a
4158   //   big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
4159   //   file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
4160   //   This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
4161   //   instruction.
4162   //
4163   //   When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
4164   //   instruction stored as two 16-bit values.  The addend A is the
4165   //   contents of the targ26 field.  The calculation is the same as
4166   //   R_MIPS_26.  When storing the calculated value, reorder the
4167   //   immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
4168   //   value as two 16-bit values.
4169   //
4170   //   To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
4171   //   defined as
4172   //
4173   //   big-endian:
4174   //   +--------+----------------------+
4175   //   |        |                      |
4176   //   |        |    targ26-16         |
4177   //   |31    26|25                   0|
4178   //   +--------+----------------------+
4179   //
4180   //   little-endian:
4181   //   +----------+------+-------------+
4182   //   |          |      |             |
4183   //   |  sub1    |      |     sub2    |
4184   //   |0        9|10  15|16         31|
4185   //   +----------+--------------------+
4186   //   where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
4187   //   ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
4188   //
4189   //   When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
4190   //   (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
4191   //   When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
4192   //   let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
4193   //   ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
4194   //
4195   //   The table below lists the other MIPS16 instruction relocations.
4196   //   Each one is calculated in the same way as the non-MIPS16 relocation
4197   //   given on the right, but using the extended MIPS16 layout of 16-bit
4198   //   immediate fields:
4199   //
4200   //      R_MIPS16_GPREL          R_MIPS_GPREL16
4201   //      R_MIPS16_GOT16          R_MIPS_GOT16
4202   //      R_MIPS16_CALL16         R_MIPS_CALL16
4203   //      R_MIPS16_HI16           R_MIPS_HI16
4204   //      R_MIPS16_LO16           R_MIPS_LO16
4205   //
4206   //   A typical instruction will have a format like this:
4207   //
4208   //   +--------------+--------------------------------+
4209   //   |    EXTEND    |     Imm 10:5    |   Imm 15:11  |
4210   //   +--------------+--------------------------------+
4211   //   |    Major     |   rx   |   ry   |   Imm  4:0   |
4212   //   +--------------+--------------------------------+
4213   //
4214   //   EXTEND is the five bit value 11110.  Major is the instruction
4215   //   opcode.
4216   //
4217   //   All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.
4218   //   As above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
4219   //   little-endian system.
4220
4221   // Similar to MIPS16, the two 16-bit halves in microMIPS must be swapped
4222   // on a little-endian system.  This does not apply to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
4223   // and R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1 relocs that apply to 16-bit instructions.
4224
4225   static void
4226   mips_reloc_unshuffle(unsigned char* view, unsigned int r_type,
4227                        bool jal_shuffle)
4228   {
4229     if (!mips16_reloc(r_type)
4230         && !should_shuffle_micromips_reloc(r_type))
4231       return;
4232
4233     // Pick up the first and second halfwords of the instruction.
4234     Valtype16 first = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(view);
4235     Valtype16 second = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(view + 2);
4236     Valtype32 val;
4237
4238     if (micromips_reloc(r_type)
4239         || (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
4240       val = first << 16 | second;
4241     else if (r_type != elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26)
4242       val = (((first & 0xf800) << 16) | ((second & 0xffe0) << 11)
4243              | ((first & 0x1f) << 11) | (first & 0x7e0) | (second & 0x1f));
4244     else
4245       val = (((first & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((first & 0x3e0) << 11)
4246              | ((first & 0x1f) << 21) | second);
4247
4248     elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(view, val);
4249   }
4250
4251   static void
4252   mips_reloc_shuffle(unsigned char* view, unsigned int r_type, bool jal_shuffle)
4253   {
4254     if (!mips16_reloc(r_type)
4255         && !should_shuffle_micromips_reloc(r_type))
4256       return;
4257
4258     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
4259     Valtype16 first, second;
4260
4261     if (micromips_reloc(r_type)
4262         || (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
4263       {
4264         second = val & 0xffff;
4265         first = val >> 16;
4266       }
4267     else if (r_type != elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26)
4268       {
4269         second = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
4270         first = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
4271       }
4272     else
4273       {
4274         second = val & 0xffff;
4275         first = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
4276                  | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
4277       }
4278
4279     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(view + 2, second);
4280     elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(view, first);
4281   }
4282
4283   // R_MIPS_16: S + sign-extend(A)
4284   static inline typename This::Status
4285   rel16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4286         const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4287         bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4288   {
4289     Valtype16* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype16*>(view);
4290     Valtype16 val = elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4291
4292     Valtype addend = (extract_addend ? Bits<16>::sign_extend32(val)
4293                                      : addend_a);
4294
4295     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
4296     val = Bits<16>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffffU);
4297
4298     if (calculate_only)
4299       {
4300         *calculated_value = x;
4301         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4302       }
4303     else
4304       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4305
4306     return check_overflow<16>(x);
4307   }
4308
4309   // R_MIPS_32: S + A
4310   static inline typename This::Status
4311   rel32(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4312         const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4313         bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4314   {
4315     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4316     Valtype addend = (extract_addend
4317                         ? elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv)
4318                         : addend_a);
4319     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend);
4320
4321     if (calculate_only)
4322       *calculated_value = x;
4323     else
4324       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
4325
4326     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4327   }
4328
4329   // R_MIPS_JALR, R_MICROMIPS_JALR
4330   static inline typename This::Status
4331   reljalr(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4332           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4333           Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool cross_mode_jump,
4334           unsigned int r_type, bool jalr_to_bal, bool jr_to_b,
4335           bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4336   {
4337     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4338     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? 0 : addend_a;
4339     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4340
4341     // Try converting J(AL)R to B(AL), if the target is in range.
4342     if (!parameters->options().relocatable()
4343         && r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR
4344         && !cross_mode_jump
4345         && ((jalr_to_bal && val == 0x0320f809)    // jalr t9
4346             || (jr_to_b && val == 0x03200008)))   // jr t9
4347       {
4348         int offset = psymval->value(object, addend) - (address + 4);
4349         if (!Bits<18>::has_overflow32(offset))
4350           {
4351             if (val == 0x03200008)   // jr t9
4352               val = 0x10000000 | (((Valtype32)offset >> 2) & 0xffff);  // b addr
4353             else
4354               val = 0x04110000 | (((Valtype32)offset >> 2) & 0xffff); //bal addr
4355           }
4356       }
4357
4358     if (calculate_only)
4359       *calculated_value = val;
4360     else
4361       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4362
4363     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4364   }
4365
4366   // R_MIPS_PC32: S + A - P
4367   static inline typename This::Status
4368   relpc32(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4369           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4370           Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
4371           Valtype* calculated_value)
4372   {
4373     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4374     Valtype addend = (extract_addend
4375                         ? elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv)
4376                         : addend_a);
4377     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - address;
4378
4379     if (calculate_only)
4380        *calculated_value = x;
4381     else
4382       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
4383
4384     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4385   }
4386
4387   // R_MIPS_26, R_MIPS16_26, R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
4388   static inline typename This::Status
4389   rel26(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4390         const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4391         bool local, Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend,
4392         const Symbol* gsym, bool cross_mode_jump, unsigned int r_type,
4393         bool jal_to_bal, bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4394   {
4395     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4396     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4397
4398     Valtype addend;
4399     if (extract_addend)
4400       {
4401         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
4402           addend = (val & 0x03ffffff) << 1;
4403         else
4404           addend = (val & 0x03ffffff) << 2;
4405       }
4406     else
4407       addend = addend_a;
4408
4409     // Make sure the target of JALX is word-aligned.  Bit 0 must be
4410     // the correct ISA mode selector and bit 1 must be 0.
4411     if (!calculate_only && cross_mode_jump
4412         && (psymval->value(object, 0) & 3) != (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_26))
4413       {
4414         gold_warning(_("JALX to a non-word-aligned address"));
4415         return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4416       }
4417
4418     // Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX.
4419     unsigned int shift =
4420         (!cross_mode_jump && r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1) ? 1 : 2;
4421
4422     Valtype x;
4423     if (local)
4424       x = addend | ((address + 4) & (0xfc000000 << shift));
4425     else
4426       {
4427         if (shift == 1)
4428           x = Bits<27>::sign_extend32(addend);
4429         else
4430           x = Bits<28>::sign_extend32(addend);
4431       }
4432     x = psymval->value(object, x) >> shift;
4433
4434     if (!calculate_only && !local && !gsym->is_weak_undefined())
4435       {
4436         if ((x >> 26) != ((address + 4) >> (26 + shift)))
4437           {
4438             gold_error(_("relocation truncated to fit: %u against '%s'"),
4439                        r_type, gsym->name());
4440             return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
4441           }
4442       }
4443
4444     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0x03ffffff);
4445
4446     // If required, turn JAL into JALX.
4447     if (cross_mode_jump)
4448       {
4449         bool ok;
4450         Valtype32 opcode = val >> 26;
4451         Valtype32 jalx_opcode;
4452
4453         // Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX.
4454         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26)
4455           {
4456             ok = (opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7);
4457             jalx_opcode = 0x7;
4458           }
4459         else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
4460           {
4461             ok = (opcode == 0x3d) || (opcode == 0x3c);
4462             jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
4463           }
4464         else
4465           {
4466             ok = (opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d);
4467             jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
4468           }
4469
4470         // If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem.  We cannot
4471         // convert J or JALS to JALX.
4472         if (!calculate_only && !ok)
4473           {
4474             gold_error(_("Unsupported jump between ISA modes; consider "
4475                          "recompiling with interlinking enabled."));
4476             return This::STATUS_BAD_RELOC;
4477           }
4478
4479         // Make this the JALX opcode.
4480         val = (val & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
4481       }
4482
4483     // Try converting JAL to BAL, if the target is in range.
4484     if (!parameters->options().relocatable()
4485         && !cross_mode_jump
4486         && ((jal_to_bal
4487             && r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_26
4488             && (val >> 26) == 0x3)))    // jal addr
4489       {
4490         Valtype32 dest = (x << 2) | (((address + 4) >> 28) << 28);
4491         int offset = dest - (address + 4);
4492         if (!Bits<18>::has_overflow32(offset))
4493           {
4494             if (val == 0x03200008)   // jr t9
4495               val = 0x10000000 | (((Valtype32)offset >> 2) & 0xffff);  // b addr
4496             else
4497               val = 0x04110000 | (((Valtype32)offset >> 2) & 0xffff); //bal addr
4498           }
4499       }
4500
4501     if (calculate_only)
4502       *calculated_value = val;
4503     else
4504       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4505
4506     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4507   }
4508
4509   // R_MIPS_PC16
4510   static inline typename This::Status
4511   relpc16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4512           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4513           Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
4514           Valtype* calculated_value)
4515   {
4516     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4517     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4518
4519     Valtype addend = (extract_addend
4520                       ? Bits<18>::sign_extend32((val & 0xffff) << 2)
4521                       : addend_a);
4522
4523     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - address;
4524     val = Bits<16>::bit_select32(val, x >> 2, 0xffff);
4525
4526     if (calculate_only)
4527       {
4528         *calculated_value = x >> 2;
4529         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4530       }
4531     else
4532       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4533
4534     return check_overflow<18>(x);
4535   }
4536
4537   // R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
4538   static inline typename This::Status
4539   relmicromips_pc7_s1(unsigned char* view,
4540                       const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4541                       const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4542                       Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend,
4543                       bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4544   {
4545     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4546     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4547
4548     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? Bits<8>::sign_extend32((val & 0x7f) << 1)
4549                                     : addend_a;
4550
4551     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - address;
4552     val = Bits<16>::bit_select32(val, x >> 1, 0x7f);
4553
4554     if (calculate_only)
4555       {
4556         *calculated_value = x >> 1;
4557         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4558       }
4559     else
4560       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4561
4562     return check_overflow<8>(x);
4563   }
4564
4565   // R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
4566   static inline typename This::Status
4567   relmicromips_pc10_s1(unsigned char* view,
4568                        const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4569                        const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4570                        Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend,
4571                        bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4572   {
4573     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4574     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4575
4576     Valtype addend = (extract_addend
4577                       ? Bits<11>::sign_extend32((val & 0x3ff) << 1)
4578                       : addend_a);
4579
4580     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - address;
4581     val = Bits<16>::bit_select32(val, x >> 1, 0x3ff);
4582
4583     if (calculate_only)
4584       {
4585         *calculated_value = x >> 1;
4586         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4587       }
4588     else
4589       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4590
4591     return check_overflow<11>(x);
4592   }
4593
4594   // R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
4595   static inline typename This::Status
4596   relmicromips_pc16_s1(unsigned char* view,
4597                        const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4598                        const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address address,
4599                        Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend,
4600                        bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4601   {
4602     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4603     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4604
4605     Valtype addend = (extract_addend
4606                       ? Bits<17>::sign_extend32((val & 0xffff) << 1)
4607                       : addend_a);
4608
4609     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - address;
4610     val = Bits<16>::bit_select32(val, x >> 1, 0xffff);
4611
4612     if (calculate_only)
4613       {
4614         *calculated_value = x >> 1;
4615         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4616       }
4617     else
4618       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4619
4620     return check_overflow<17>(x);
4621   }
4622
4623   // R_MIPS_HI16, R_MIPS16_HI16, R_MICROMIPS_HI16,
4624   static inline typename This::Status
4625   relhi16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4626           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend,
4627           Mips_address address, bool gp_disp, unsigned int r_type,
4628           unsigned int r_sym, bool extract_addend)
4629   {
4630     // Record the relocation.  It will be resolved when we find lo16 part.
4631     hi16_relocs.push_back(reloc_high<size, big_endian>(view, object, psymval,
4632                           addend, r_type, r_sym, extract_addend, address,
4633                           gp_disp));
4634     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4635   }
4636
4637   // R_MIPS_HI16, R_MIPS16_HI16, R_MICROMIPS_HI16,
4638   static inline typename This::Status
4639   do_relhi16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4640              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_hi,
4641              Mips_address address, bool is_gp_disp, unsigned int r_type,
4642              bool extract_addend, Valtype32 addend_lo,
4643              Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, bool calculate_only,
4644              Valtype* calculated_value)
4645   {
4646     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4647     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4648
4649     Valtype addend = (extract_addend ? ((val & 0xffff) << 16) + addend_lo
4650                                        : addend_hi);
4651
4652     Valtype32 value;
4653     if (!is_gp_disp)
4654       value = psymval->value(object, addend);
4655     else
4656       {
4657         // For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
4658         //    0: li      $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
4659         //    4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
4660         //    8: sll     $v0,16
4661         //   12: addu    $v0,$v1
4662         //   14: move    $gp,$v0
4663         // So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
4664         // base $pc is that used by the ADDIUPC instruction at $t9 + 4.
4665         // ADDIUPC clears the low two bits of the instruction address,
4666         // so the base is ($t9 + 4) & ~3.
4667         Valtype32 gp_disp;
4668         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16)
4669           gp_disp = (target->adjusted_gp_value(object)
4670                      - ((address + 4) & ~0x3));
4671         // The microMIPS .cpload sequence uses the same assembly
4672         // instructions as the traditional psABI version, but the
4673         // incoming $t9 has the low bit set.
4674         else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16)
4675           gp_disp = target->adjusted_gp_value(object) - address - 1;
4676         else
4677           gp_disp = target->adjusted_gp_value(object) - address;
4678         value = gp_disp + addend;
4679       }
4680     Valtype x = ((value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
4681     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4682
4683     if (calculate_only)
4684       {
4685         *calculated_value = x;
4686         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4687       }
4688     else
4689       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4690
4691     return (is_gp_disp ? check_overflow<16>(x)
4692                        : This::STATUS_OKAY);
4693   }
4694
4695   // R_MIPS_GOT16, R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MICROMIPS_GOT16
4696   static inline typename This::Status
4697   relgot16_local(unsigned char* view,
4698                  const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4699                  const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4700                  bool extract_addend, unsigned int r_type, unsigned int r_sym)
4701   {
4702     // Record the relocation.  It will be resolved when we find lo16 part.
4703     got16_relocs.push_back(reloc_high<size, big_endian>(view, object, psymval,
4704                            addend_a, r_type, r_sym, extract_addend));
4705     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4706   }
4707
4708   // R_MIPS_GOT16, R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MICROMIPS_GOT16
4709   static inline typename This::Status
4710   do_relgot16_local(unsigned char* view,
4711                     const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4712                     const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_hi,
4713                     bool extract_addend, Valtype32 addend_lo,
4714                     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, bool calculate_only,
4715                     Valtype* calculated_value)
4716   {
4717     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4718     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4719
4720     Valtype addend = (extract_addend ? ((val & 0xffff) << 16) + addend_lo
4721                                        : addend_hi);
4722
4723     // Find GOT page entry.
4724     Mips_address value = ((psymval->value(object, addend) + 0x8000) >> 16)
4725                           & 0xffff;
4726     value <<= 16;
4727     unsigned int got_offset =
4728       target->got_section()->get_got_page_offset(value, object);
4729
4730     // Resolve the relocation.
4731     Valtype x = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
4732     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4733
4734     if (calculate_only)
4735       {
4736         *calculated_value = x;
4737         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4738       }
4739     else
4740       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4741
4742     return check_overflow<16>(x);
4743   }
4744
4745   // R_MIPS_LO16, R_MIPS16_LO16, R_MICROMIPS_LO16, R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16
4746   static inline typename This::Status
4747   rello16(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, unsigned char* view,
4748           const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4749           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4750           bool extract_addend, Mips_address address, bool is_gp_disp,
4751           unsigned int r_type, unsigned int r_sym, unsigned int rel_type,
4752           bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
4753   {
4754     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4755     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4756
4757     Valtype addend = (extract_addend ? Bits<16>::sign_extend32(val & 0xffff)
4758                                      : addend_a);
4759
4760     if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
4761       {
4762         typename This::Status reloc_status = This::STATUS_OKAY;
4763         // Resolve pending R_MIPS_HI16 relocations.
4764         typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> >::iterator it =
4765           hi16_relocs.begin();
4766         while (it != hi16_relocs.end())
4767           {
4768             reloc_high<size, big_endian> hi16 = *it;
4769             if (hi16.r_sym == r_sym
4770                 && is_matching_lo16_reloc(hi16.r_type, r_type))
4771               {
4772                 mips_reloc_unshuffle(hi16.view, hi16.r_type, false);
4773                 reloc_status = do_relhi16(hi16.view, hi16.object, hi16.psymval,
4774                                        hi16.addend, hi16.address, hi16.gp_disp,
4775                                        hi16.r_type, hi16.extract_addend, addend,
4776                                        target, calculate_only, calculated_value);
4777                 mips_reloc_shuffle(hi16.view, hi16.r_type, false);
4778                 if (reloc_status == This::STATUS_OVERFLOW)
4779                   return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
4780                 it = hi16_relocs.erase(it);
4781               }
4782             else
4783               ++it;
4784           }
4785
4786         // Resolve pending local R_MIPS_GOT16 relocations.
4787         typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> >::iterator it2 =
4788           got16_relocs.begin();
4789         while (it2 != got16_relocs.end())
4790           {
4791             reloc_high<size, big_endian> got16 = *it2;
4792             if (got16.r_sym == r_sym
4793                 && is_matching_lo16_reloc(got16.r_type, r_type))
4794               {
4795                 mips_reloc_unshuffle(got16.view, got16.r_type, false);
4796
4797                 reloc_status = do_relgot16_local(got16.view, got16.object,
4798                                      got16.psymval, got16.addend,
4799                                      got16.extract_addend, addend, target,
4800                                      calculate_only, calculated_value);
4801
4802                 mips_reloc_shuffle(got16.view, got16.r_type, false);
4803                 if (reloc_status == This::STATUS_OVERFLOW)
4804                   return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
4805                 it2 = got16_relocs.erase(it2);
4806               }
4807             else
4808               ++it2;
4809           }
4810       }
4811
4812     // Resolve R_MIPS_LO16 relocation.
4813     Valtype x;
4814     if (!is_gp_disp)
4815       x = psymval->value(object, addend);
4816     else
4817       {
4818         // See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
4819         // for this conditional.
4820         Valtype32 gp_disp;
4821         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16)
4822           gp_disp = target->adjusted_gp_value(object) - (address & ~0x3);
4823         else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16
4824                  || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16)
4825           gp_disp = target->adjusted_gp_value(object) - address + 3;
4826         else
4827           gp_disp = target->adjusted_gp_value(object) - address + 4;
4828         // The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
4829         // for overflow.  Relocations against _gp_disp are normally
4830         // generated from the .cpload pseudo-op.  It generates code
4831         // that normally looks like this:
4832
4833         //   lui    $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
4834         //   addiu  $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
4835         //   addu   $gp,$gp,$t9
4836
4837         // Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
4838         // as required by the MIPS ELF ABI.  The R_MIPS_LO16
4839         // relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
4840         // R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
4841         // Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
4842         // not check for overflow here.
4843         x = gp_disp + addend;
4844       }
4845     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4846
4847     if (calculate_only)
4848       *calculated_value = x;
4849     else
4850       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4851
4852     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4853   }
4854
4855   // R_MIPS_CALL16, R_MIPS16_CALL16, R_MICROMIPS_CALL16
4856   // R_MIPS_GOT16, R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MICROMIPS_GOT16
4857   // R_MIPS_TLS_GD, R_MIPS16_TLS_GD, R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD
4858   // R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL, R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL, R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL
4859   // R_MIPS_TLS_LDM, R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM, R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM
4860   // R_MIPS_GOT_DISP, R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP
4861   static inline typename This::Status
4862   relgot(unsigned char* view, int gp_offset, bool calculate_only,
4863          Valtype* calculated_value)
4864   {
4865     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4866     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4867     Valtype x = gp_offset;
4868     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4869
4870     if (calculate_only)
4871       {
4872         *calculated_value = x;
4873         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4874       }
4875     else
4876       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4877
4878     return check_overflow<16>(x);
4879   }
4880
4881   // R_MIPS_EH
4882   static inline typename This::Status
4883   releh(unsigned char* view, int gp_offset, bool calculate_only,
4884         Valtype* calculated_value)
4885   {
4886     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4887     Valtype x = gp_offset;
4888
4889     if (calculate_only)
4890       {
4891         *calculated_value = x;
4892         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4893       }
4894     else
4895       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
4896
4897     return check_overflow<32>(x);
4898   }
4899
4900   // R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE, R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE
4901   static inline typename This::Status
4902   relgotpage(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, unsigned char* view,
4903              const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4904              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4905              bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
4906              Valtype* calculated_value)
4907   {
4908     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4909     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
4910     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val & 0xffff : addend_a;
4911
4912     // Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of symbol + addend.
4913     Mips_address value = (psymval->value(object, addend) + 0x8000) & ~0xffff;
4914     unsigned int  got_offset =
4915       target->got_section()->get_got_page_offset(value, object);
4916
4917     Valtype x = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
4918     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4919
4920     if (calculate_only)
4921       {
4922         *calculated_value = x;
4923         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4924       }
4925     else
4926       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4927
4928     return check_overflow<16>(x);
4929   }
4930
4931   // R_MIPS_GOT_OFST, R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST
4932   static inline typename This::Status
4933   relgotofst(Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, unsigned char* view,
4934              const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
4935              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
4936              bool extract_addend, bool local, bool calculate_only,
4937              Valtype* calculated_value)
4938   {
4939     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4940     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
4941     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val & 0xffff : addend_a;
4942
4943     // For a local symbol, find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of
4944     // symbol + addend.  Relocation value is the offset of the GOT page entry's
4945     // value from symbol + addend.
4946     // For a global symbol, relocation value is addend.
4947     Valtype x;
4948     if (local)
4949       {
4950         // Find GOT page entry.
4951         Mips_address value = ((psymval->value(object, addend) + 0x8000)
4952                               & ~0xffff);
4953         target->got_section()->get_got_page_offset(value, object);
4954
4955         x = psymval->value(object, addend) - value;
4956       }
4957     else
4958       x = addend;
4959     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4960
4961     if (calculate_only)
4962       {
4963         *calculated_value = x;
4964         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4965       }
4966     else
4967       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4968
4969     return check_overflow<16>(x);
4970   }
4971
4972   // R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, R_MIPS_CALL_HI16,
4973   // R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16, R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16
4974   static inline typename This::Status
4975   relgot_hi16(unsigned char* view, int gp_offset, bool calculate_only,
4976               Valtype* calculated_value)
4977   {
4978     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4979     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
4980     Valtype x = gp_offset;
4981     x = ((x + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
4982     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
4983
4984     if (calculate_only)
4985       *calculated_value = x;
4986     else
4987       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
4988
4989     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
4990   }
4991
4992   // R_MIPS_GOT_LO16, R_MIPS_CALL_LO16,
4993   // R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16, R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16
4994   static inline typename This::Status
4995   relgot_lo16(unsigned char* view, int gp_offset, bool calculate_only,
4996               Valtype* calculated_value)
4997   {
4998     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
4999     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5000     Valtype x = gp_offset;
5001     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
5002
5003     if (calculate_only)
5004       *calculated_value = x;
5005     else
5006       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
5007
5008     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5009   }
5010
5011   // R_MIPS_GPREL16, R_MIPS16_GPREL, R_MIPS_LITERAL, R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL
5012   // R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2, R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16
5013   static inline typename This::Status
5014   relgprel(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5015            const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address gp,
5016            Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool local,
5017            unsigned int r_type, bool calculate_only,
5018            Valtype* calculated_value)
5019   {
5020     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
5021     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5022
5023     Valtype addend;
5024     if (extract_addend)
5025       {
5026         if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2)
5027           addend = (val & 0x7f) << 2;
5028         else
5029           addend = val & 0xffff;
5030         // Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
5031         // instruction.  If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
5032         // otherwise we may lose significant bits.
5033         addend = Bits<16>::sign_extend32(addend);
5034       }
5035     else
5036       addend = addend_a;
5037
5038     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - gp;
5039
5040     // If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
5041     // have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
5042     // for that now.  Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
5043     // link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
5044     // to them before.
5045     if (local)
5046       x += object->gp_value();
5047
5048     if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2)
5049       val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0x7f);
5050     else
5051       val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
5052
5053     if (calculate_only)
5054       {
5055         *calculated_value = x;
5056         return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5057       }
5058     else
5059       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
5060
5061     if (check_overflow<16>(x) == This::STATUS_OVERFLOW)
5062       {
5063         gold_error(_("small-data section exceeds 64KB; lower small-data size "
5064                      "limit (see option -G)"));
5065         return This::STATUS_OVERFLOW;
5066       }
5067     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5068   }
5069
5070   // R_MIPS_GPREL32
5071   static inline typename This::Status
5072   relgprel32(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5073              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address gp,
5074              Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
5075              Valtype* calculated_value)
5076   {
5077     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
5078     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5079     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val : addend_a;
5080
5081     // R_MIPS_GPREL32 relocations are defined for local symbols only.
5082     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) + object->gp_value() - gp;
5083
5084     if (calculate_only)
5085       *calculated_value = x;
5086     else
5087       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
5088
5089     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5090  }
5091
5092   // R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16, R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16, R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16
5093   // R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16, R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16,
5094   // R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16
5095   static inline typename This::Status
5096   tlsrelhi16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5097              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Valtype32 tp_offset,
5098              Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
5099              Valtype* calculated_value)
5100   {
5101     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
5102     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5103     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val & 0xffff : addend_a;
5104
5105     // tls symbol values are relative to tls_segment()->vaddr()
5106     Valtype x = ((psymval->value(object, addend) - tp_offset) + 0x8000) >> 16;
5107     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
5108
5109     if (calculate_only)
5110       *calculated_value = x;
5111     else
5112       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
5113
5114     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5115   }
5116
5117   // R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16, R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16, R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16,
5118   // R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16, R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16,
5119   // R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16,
5120   static inline typename This::Status
5121   tlsrello16(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5122              const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Valtype32 tp_offset,
5123              Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
5124              Valtype* calculated_value)
5125   {
5126     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
5127     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5128     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val & 0xffff : addend_a;
5129
5130     // tls symbol values are relative to tls_segment()->vaddr()
5131     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - tp_offset;
5132     val = Bits<32>::bit_select32(val, x, 0xffff);
5133
5134     if (calculate_only)
5135       *calculated_value = x;
5136     else
5137       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, val);
5138
5139     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5140   }
5141
5142   // R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32, R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64,
5143   // R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32, R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64
5144   static inline typename This::Status
5145   tlsrel32(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5146            const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Valtype32 tp_offset,
5147            Mips_address addend_a, bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only,
5148            Valtype* calculated_value)
5149   {
5150     Valtype32* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype32*>(view);
5151     Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(wv);
5152     Valtype addend = extract_addend ? val : addend_a;
5153
5154     // tls symbol values are relative to tls_segment()->vaddr()
5155     Valtype x = psymval->value(object, addend) - tp_offset;
5156
5157     if (calculate_only)
5158       *calculated_value = x;
5159     else
5160       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
5161
5162     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5163   }
5164
5165   // R_MIPS_SUB, R_MICROMIPS_SUB
5166   static inline typename This::Status
5167   relsub(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5168          const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
5169          bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value)
5170   {
5171     Valtype64* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype64*>(view);
5172     Valtype64 addend = (extract_addend
5173                         ? elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::readval(wv)
5174                         : addend_a);
5175
5176     Valtype64 x = psymval->value(object, -addend);
5177     if (calculate_only)
5178       *calculated_value = x;
5179     else
5180       elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
5181
5182     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5183   }
5184
5185   // R_MIPS_64: S + A
5186   static inline typename This::Status
5187   rel64(unsigned char* view, const Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5188         const Symbol_value<size>* psymval, Mips_address addend_a,
5189         bool extract_addend, bool calculate_only, Valtype* calculated_value,
5190         bool apply_addend_only)
5191   {
5192     Valtype64* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype64*>(view);
5193     Valtype64 addend = (extract_addend
5194                         ? elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::readval(wv)
5195                         : addend_a);
5196
5197     Valtype64 x = psymval->value(object, addend);
5198     if (calculate_only)
5199       *calculated_value = x;
5200     else
5201       {
5202         if (apply_addend_only)
5203           x = addend;
5204         elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
5205       }
5206
5207     return This::STATUS_OKAY;
5208   }
5209
5210 };
5211
5212 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5213 typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> >
5214     Mips_relocate_functions<size, big_endian>::hi16_relocs;
5215
5216 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5217 typename std::list<reloc_high<size, big_endian> >
5218     Mips_relocate_functions<size, big_endian>::got16_relocs;
5219
5220 // Mips_got_info methods.
5221
5222 // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against symbol
5223 // SYMNDX + ADDEND, where SYMNDX is a local symbol in section SHNDX in OBJECT.
5224
5225 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5226 void
5227 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::record_local_got_symbol(
5228     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object, unsigned int symndx,
5229     Mips_address addend, unsigned int r_type, unsigned int shndx,
5230     bool is_section_symbol)
5231 {
5232   Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry =
5233     new Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>(object, symndx, addend,
5234                                          mips_elf_reloc_tls_type(r_type),
5235                                          shndx, is_section_symbol);
5236   this->record_got_entry(entry, object);
5237 }
5238
5239 // Reserve GOT entry for a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against MIPS_SYM,
5240 // in OBJECT.  FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
5241 // using the GOT entry for calls.  DYN_RELOC is true if R_TYPE is a dynamic
5242 // relocation.
5243
5244 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5245 void
5246 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::record_global_got_symbol(
5247     Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym, Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
5248     unsigned int r_type, bool dyn_reloc, bool for_call)
5249 {
5250   if (!for_call)
5251     mips_sym->set_got_not_only_for_calls();
5252
5253   // A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol table.
5254   if (!mips_sym->needs_dynsym_entry())
5255     {
5256       switch (mips_sym->visibility())
5257         {
5258         case elfcpp::STV_INTERNAL:
5259         case elfcpp::STV_HIDDEN:
5260           mips_sym->set_is_forced_local();
5261           break;
5262         default:
5263           mips_sym->set_needs_dynsym_entry();
5264           break;
5265         }
5266     }
5267
5268   unsigned char tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type(r_type);
5269   if (tls_type == GOT_TLS_NONE)
5270     this->global_got_symbols_.insert(mips_sym);
5271
5272   if (dyn_reloc)
5273     {
5274       if (mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_NONE)
5275         mips_sym->set_global_got_area(GGA_RELOC_ONLY);
5276       return;
5277     }
5278
5279   Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry =
5280     new Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>(object, mips_sym, tls_type);
5281
5282   this->record_got_entry(entry, object);
5283 }
5284
5285 // Add ENTRY to master GOT and to OBJECT's GOT.
5286
5287 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5288 void
5289 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::record_got_entry(
5290     Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry,
5291     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object)
5292 {
5293   if (this->got_entries_.find(entry) == this->got_entries_.end())
5294     this->got_entries_.insert(entry);
5295
5296   // Create the GOT entry for the OBJECT's GOT.
5297   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = object->get_or_create_got_info();
5298   Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry2 =
5299     new Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>(*entry);
5300
5301   if (g->got_entries_.find(entry2) == g->got_entries_.end())
5302     g->got_entries_.insert(entry2);
5303 }
5304
5305 // Record that OBJECT has a page relocation against symbol SYMNDX and
5306 // that ADDEND is the addend for that relocation.
5307 // This function creates an upper bound on the number of GOT slots
5308 // required; no attempt is made to combine references to non-overridable
5309 // global symbols across multiple input files.
5310
5311 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5312 void
5313 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::record_got_page_entry(
5314     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object, unsigned int symndx, int addend)
5315 {
5316   struct Got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
5317   int old_pages, new_pages;
5318
5319   // Find the Got_page_entry for this symbol.
5320   Got_page_entry* entry = new Got_page_entry(object, symndx);
5321   typename Got_page_entry_set::iterator it =
5322     this->got_page_entries_.find(entry);
5323   if (it != this->got_page_entries_.end())
5324     entry = *it;
5325   else
5326     this->got_page_entries_.insert(entry);
5327
5328   // Add the same entry to the OBJECT's GOT.
5329   Got_page_entry* entry2 = NULL;
5330   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g2 = object->get_or_create_got_info();
5331   if (g2->got_page_entries_.find(entry) == g2->got_page_entries_.end())
5332     {
5333       entry2 = new Got_page_entry(*entry);
5334       g2->got_page_entries_.insert(entry2);
5335     }
5336
5337   // Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
5338   // with ADDEND.
5339   range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
5340   while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
5341     range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
5342
5343   // If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
5344   // minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
5345   // a new singleton range.
5346   range = *range_ptr;
5347   if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
5348     {
5349       range = new Got_page_range();
5350       range->next = *range_ptr;
5351       range->min_addend = addend;
5352       range->max_addend = addend;
5353
5354       *range_ptr = range;
5355       ++entry->num_pages;
5356       if (entry2 != NULL)
5357         ++entry2->num_pages;
5358       ++this->page_gotno_;
5359       ++g2->page_gotno_;
5360       return;
5361     }
5362
5363   // Remember how many pages the old range contributed.
5364   old_pages = range->get_max_pages();
5365
5366   // Update the ranges.
5367   if (addend < range->min_addend)
5368     range->min_addend = addend;
5369   else if (addend > range->max_addend)
5370     {
5371       if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
5372         {
5373           old_pages += range->next->get_max_pages();
5374           range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
5375           range->next = range->next->next;
5376         }
5377       else
5378         range->max_addend = addend;
5379     }
5380
5381   // Record any change in the total estimate.
5382   new_pages = range->get_max_pages();
5383   if (old_pages != new_pages)
5384     {
5385       entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
5386       if (entry2 != NULL)
5387         entry2->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
5388       this->page_gotno_ += new_pages - old_pages;
5389       g2->page_gotno_ += new_pages - old_pages;
5390     }
5391 }
5392
5393 // Create all entries that should be in the local part of the GOT.
5394
5395 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5396 void
5397 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_local_entries(
5398     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout)
5399 {
5400   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got = target->got_section();
5401   // First two GOT entries are reserved.  The first entry will be filled at
5402   // runtime.  The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
5403   got->add_constant(0);
5404   got->add_constant(target->mips_elf_gnu_got1_mask());
5405
5406   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5407        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5408        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5409        ++p)
5410     {
5411       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5412       if (entry->is_for_local_symbol() && !entry->is_tls_entry())
5413         {
5414           got->add_local(entry->object(), entry->symndx(),
5415                          GOT_TYPE_STANDARD, entry->addend());
5416           unsigned int got_offset = entry->object()->local_got_offset(
5417               entry->symndx(), GOT_TYPE_STANDARD, entry->addend());
5418           if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ > 0
5419               && parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
5420           {
5421             if (!entry->is_section_symbol())
5422               target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_local(entry->object(),
5423                   entry->symndx(), elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, got, got_offset);
5424             else
5425               target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_symbolless_local_addend(
5426                   entry->object(), entry->symndx(), elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32,
5427                   got, got_offset);
5428           }
5429         }
5430     }
5431
5432   this->add_page_entries(target, layout);
5433
5434   // Add global entries that should be in the local area.
5435   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5436        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5437        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5438        ++p)
5439     {
5440       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5441       if (!entry->is_for_global_symbol())
5442         continue;
5443
5444       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = entry->sym();
5445       if (mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_NONE && !entry->is_tls_entry())
5446         {
5447           unsigned int got_type;
5448           if (!got->multi_got())
5449             got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD;
5450           else
5451             got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
5452           if (got->add_global(mips_sym, got_type))
5453             {
5454               mips_sym->set_global_gotoffset(mips_sym->got_offset(got_type));
5455               if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ > 0
5456                   && parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
5457                 target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_symbolless_global_addend(
5458                     mips_sym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, got,
5459                     mips_sym->got_offset(got_type));
5460             }
5461         }
5462     }
5463 }
5464
5465 // Create GOT page entries.
5466
5467 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5468 void
5469 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_page_entries(
5470     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout)
5471 {
5472   if (this->page_gotno_ == 0)
5473     return;
5474
5475   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got = target->got_section();
5476   this->got_page_offset_start_ = got->add_constant(0);
5477   if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ > 0
5478       && parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
5479     target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_absolute(elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, got,
5480                                                   this->got_page_offset_start_);
5481   int num_entries = this->page_gotno_;
5482   unsigned int prev_offset = this->got_page_offset_start_;
5483   while (--num_entries > 0)
5484     {
5485       unsigned int next_offset = got->add_constant(0);
5486       if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ > 0
5487           && parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
5488         target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_absolute(elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, got,
5489                                                       next_offset);
5490       gold_assert(next_offset == prev_offset + size/8);
5491       prev_offset = next_offset;
5492     }
5493   this->got_page_offset_next_ = this->got_page_offset_start_;
5494 }
5495
5496 // Create global GOT entries, both GGA_NORMAL and GGA_RELOC_ONLY.
5497
5498 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5499 void
5500 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_global_entries(
5501     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout,
5502     unsigned int non_reloc_only_global_gotno)
5503 {
5504   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got = target->got_section();
5505   // Add GGA_NORMAL entries.
5506   unsigned int count = 0;
5507   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5508        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5509        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5510        ++p)
5511     {
5512       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5513       if (!entry->is_for_global_symbol())
5514         continue;
5515
5516       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = entry->sym();
5517       if (mips_sym->global_got_area() != GGA_NORMAL)
5518         continue;
5519
5520       unsigned int got_type;
5521       if (!got->multi_got())
5522         got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD;
5523       else
5524         // In multi-GOT links, global symbol can be in both primary and
5525         // secondary GOT(s).  By creating custom GOT type
5526         // (GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT + got_index) we ensure that symbol
5527         // is added to secondary GOT(s).
5528         got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
5529       if (!got->add_global(mips_sym, got_type))
5530         continue;
5531
5532       mips_sym->set_global_gotoffset(mips_sym->got_offset(got_type));
5533       if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ == 0)
5534         count++;
5535       if (got->multi_got() && this->index_ > 0)
5536         {
5537           if (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent()
5538               || (!parameters->doing_static_link()
5539                   && mips_sym->is_from_dynobj() && !mips_sym->is_undefined()))
5540             {
5541               target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_global(
5542                   mips_sym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, got,
5543                   mips_sym->got_offset(got_type));
5544               got->add_secondary_got_reloc(mips_sym->got_offset(got_type),
5545                                            elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, mips_sym);
5546             }
5547         }
5548     }
5549
5550   if (!got->multi_got() || this->index_ == 0)
5551     {
5552       if (got->multi_got())
5553         {
5554           // We need to allocate space in the primary GOT for GGA_NORMAL entries
5555           // of secondary GOTs, to ensure that GOT offsets of GGA_RELOC_ONLY
5556           // entries correspond to dynamic symbol indexes.
5557           while (count < non_reloc_only_global_gotno)
5558             {
5559               got->add_constant(0);
5560               ++count;
5561             }
5562         }
5563
5564       // Add GGA_RELOC_ONLY entries.
5565       got->add_reloc_only_entries();
5566     }
5567 }
5568
5569 // Create global GOT entries that should be in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area.
5570
5571 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5572 void
5573 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_reloc_only_entries(
5574     Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got)
5575 {
5576   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::iterator
5577        p = this->global_got_symbols_.begin();
5578        p != this->global_got_symbols_.end();
5579        ++p)
5580     {
5581       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
5582       if (mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
5583         {
5584           unsigned int got_type;
5585           if (!got->multi_got())
5586             got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD;
5587           else
5588             got_type = GOT_TYPE_STANDARD_MULTIGOT;
5589           if (got->add_global(mips_sym, got_type))
5590             mips_sym->set_global_gotoffset(mips_sym->got_offset(got_type));
5591         }
5592     }
5593 }
5594
5595 // Create TLS GOT entries.
5596
5597 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5598 void
5599 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_tls_entries(
5600     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, Layout* layout)
5601 {
5602   Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got = target->got_section();
5603   // Add local tls entries.
5604   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5605        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5606        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5607        ++p)
5608     {
5609       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5610       if (!entry->is_tls_entry() || !entry->is_for_local_symbol())
5611         continue;
5612
5613       if (entry->tls_type() == GOT_TLS_GD)
5614         {
5615           unsigned int got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR;
5616           unsigned int r_type1 = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32
5617                                              : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64);
5618           unsigned int r_type2 = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32
5619                                              : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64);
5620
5621           if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
5622             {
5623               got->add_local_pair_with_rel(entry->object(), entry->symndx(),
5624                                            entry->shndx(), got_type,
5625                                            target->rel_dyn_section(layout),
5626                                            r_type1, entry->addend());
5627               unsigned int got_offset =
5628                 entry->object()->local_got_offset(entry->symndx(), got_type,
5629                                                   entry->addend());
5630               got->add_static_reloc(got_offset + size/8, r_type2,
5631                                     entry->object(), entry->symndx());
5632             }
5633           else
5634             {
5635               // We are doing a static link.  Mark it as belong to module 1,
5636               // the executable.
5637               unsigned int got_offset = got->add_constant(1);
5638               entry->object()->set_local_got_offset(entry->symndx(), got_type,
5639                                                     got_offset,
5640                                                     entry->addend());
5641               got->add_constant(0);
5642               got->add_static_reloc(got_offset + size/8, r_type2,
5643                                     entry->object(), entry->symndx());
5644             }
5645         }
5646       else if (entry->tls_type() == GOT_TLS_IE)
5647         {
5648           unsigned int got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET;
5649           unsigned int r_type = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32
5650                                             : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64);
5651           if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
5652             got->add_local_with_rel(entry->object(), entry->symndx(), got_type,
5653                                     target->rel_dyn_section(layout), r_type,
5654                                     entry->addend());
5655           else
5656             {
5657               got->add_local(entry->object(), entry->symndx(), got_type,
5658                              entry->addend());
5659               unsigned int got_offset =
5660                   entry->object()->local_got_offset(entry->symndx(), got_type,
5661                                                     entry->addend());
5662               got->add_static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, entry->object(),
5663                                     entry->symndx());
5664             }
5665         }
5666       else if (entry->tls_type() == GOT_TLS_LDM)
5667         {
5668           unsigned int r_type = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32
5669                                             : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64);
5670           unsigned int got_offset;
5671           if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
5672             {
5673               got_offset = got->add_constant(0);
5674               target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_local(
5675                   entry->object(), 0, r_type, got, got_offset);
5676             }
5677           else
5678             // We are doing a static link.  Just mark it as belong to module 1,
5679             // the executable.
5680             got_offset = got->add_constant(1);
5681
5682           got->add_constant(0);
5683           got->set_tls_ldm_offset(got_offset, entry->object());
5684         }
5685       else
5686         gold_unreachable();
5687     }
5688
5689   // Add global tls entries.
5690   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5691        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5692        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5693        ++p)
5694     {
5695       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5696       if (!entry->is_tls_entry() || !entry->is_for_global_symbol())
5697         continue;
5698
5699       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = entry->sym();
5700       if (entry->tls_type() == GOT_TLS_GD)
5701         {
5702           unsigned int got_type;
5703           if (!got->multi_got())
5704             got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR;
5705           else
5706             got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
5707           unsigned int r_type1 = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32
5708                                              : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64);
5709           unsigned int r_type2 = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32
5710                                              : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64);
5711           if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
5712             got->add_global_pair_with_rel(mips_sym, got_type,
5713                              target->rel_dyn_section(layout), r_type1, r_type2);
5714           else
5715             {
5716               // Add a GOT pair for for R_MIPS_TLS_GD.  The creates a pair of
5717               // GOT entries.  The first one is initialized to be 1, which is the
5718               // module index for the main executable and the second one 0.  A
5719               // reloc of the type R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32/64 will be created for
5720               // the second GOT entry and will be applied by gold.
5721               unsigned int got_offset = got->add_constant(1);
5722               mips_sym->set_got_offset(got_type, got_offset);
5723               got->add_constant(0);
5724               got->add_static_reloc(got_offset + size/8, r_type2, mips_sym);
5725             }
5726         }
5727       else if (entry->tls_type() == GOT_TLS_IE)
5728         {
5729           unsigned int got_type;
5730           if (!got->multi_got())
5731             got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET;
5732           else
5733             got_type = GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET_MULTIGOT + this->index_;
5734           unsigned int r_type = (size == 32 ? elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32
5735                                             : elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64);
5736           if (!parameters->doing_static_link())
5737             got->add_global_with_rel(mips_sym, got_type,
5738                                      target->rel_dyn_section(layout), r_type);
5739           else
5740             {
5741               got->add_global(mips_sym, got_type);
5742               unsigned int got_offset = mips_sym->got_offset(got_type);
5743               got->add_static_reloc(got_offset, r_type, mips_sym);
5744             }
5745         }
5746       else
5747         gold_unreachable();
5748     }
5749 }
5750
5751 // Decide whether the symbol needs an entry in the global part of the primary
5752 // GOT, setting global_got_area accordingly.  Count the number of global
5753 // symbols that are in the primary GOT only because they have dynamic
5754 // relocations R_MIPS_REL32 against them (reloc_only_gotno).
5755
5756 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5757 void
5758 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::count_got_symbols(Symbol_table* symtab)
5759 {
5760   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::iterator
5761        p = this->global_got_symbols_.begin();
5762        p != this->global_got_symbols_.end();
5763        ++p)
5764     {
5765       Mips_symbol<size>* sym = *p;
5766       // Make a final decision about whether the symbol belongs in the
5767       // local or global GOT.  Symbols that bind locally can (and in the
5768       // case of forced-local symbols, must) live in the local GOT.
5769       // Those that are aren't in the dynamic symbol table must also
5770       // live in the local GOT.
5771
5772       if (!sym->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab)
5773           || (sym->got_only_for_calls()
5774               ? symbol_calls_local(sym, sym->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab))
5775               : symbol_references_local(sym,
5776                                         sym->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab))))
5777         // The symbol belongs in the local GOT.  We no longer need this
5778         // entry if it was only used for relocations; those relocations
5779         // will be against the null or section symbol instead.
5780         sym->set_global_got_area(GGA_NONE);
5781       else if (sym->global_got_area() == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
5782         {
5783           ++this->reloc_only_gotno_;
5784           ++this->global_gotno_ ;
5785         }
5786     }
5787 }
5788
5789 // Return the offset of GOT page entry for VALUE.  Initialize the entry with
5790 // VALUE if it is not initialized.
5791
5792 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5793 unsigned int
5794 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::get_got_page_offset(Mips_address value,
5795     Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got)
5796 {
5797   typename Got_page_offsets::iterator it = this->got_page_offsets_.find(value);
5798   if (it != this->got_page_offsets_.end())
5799     return it->second;
5800
5801   gold_assert(this->got_page_offset_next_ < this->got_page_offset_start_
5802               + (size/8) * this->page_gotno_);
5803
5804   unsigned int got_offset = this->got_page_offset_next_;
5805   this->got_page_offsets_[value] = got_offset;
5806   this->got_page_offset_next_ += size/8;
5807   got->update_got_entry(got_offset, value);
5808   return got_offset;
5809 }
5810
5811 // Remove lazy-binding stubs for global symbols in this GOT.
5812
5813 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5814 void
5815 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::remove_lazy_stubs(
5816     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
5817 {
5818   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5819        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5820        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5821        ++p)
5822     {
5823       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5824       if (entry->is_for_global_symbol())
5825         target->remove_lazy_stub_entry(entry->sym());
5826     }
5827 }
5828
5829 // Count the number of GOT entries required.
5830
5831 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5832 void
5833 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::count_got_entries()
5834 {
5835   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5836        p = this->got_entries_.begin();
5837        p != this->got_entries_.end();
5838        ++p)
5839     {
5840       this->count_got_entry(*p);
5841     }
5842 }
5843
5844 // Count the number of GOT entries required by ENTRY.  Accumulate the result.
5845
5846 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5847 void
5848 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::count_got_entry(
5849     Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry)
5850 {
5851   if (entry->is_tls_entry())
5852     this->tls_gotno_ += mips_tls_got_entries(entry->tls_type());
5853   else if (entry->is_for_local_symbol()
5854            || entry->sym()->global_got_area() == GGA_NONE)
5855     ++this->local_gotno_;
5856   else
5857     ++this->global_gotno_;
5858 }
5859
5860 // Add FROM's GOT entries.
5861
5862 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5863 void
5864 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_got_entries(
5865     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from)
5866 {
5867   for (typename Got_entry_set::iterator
5868        p = from->got_entries_.begin();
5869        p != from->got_entries_.end();
5870        ++p)
5871     {
5872       Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry = *p;
5873       if (this->got_entries_.find(entry) == this->got_entries_.end())
5874         {
5875           Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>* entry2 =
5876             new Mips_got_entry<size, big_endian>(*entry);
5877           this->got_entries_.insert(entry2);
5878           this->count_got_entry(entry);
5879         }
5880     }
5881 }
5882
5883 // Add FROM's GOT page entries.
5884
5885 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5886 void
5887 Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>::add_got_page_entries(
5888     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from)
5889 {
5890   for (typename Got_page_entry_set::iterator
5891        p = from->got_page_entries_.begin();
5892        p != from->got_page_entries_.end();
5893        ++p)
5894     {
5895       Got_page_entry* entry = *p;
5896       if (this->got_page_entries_.find(entry) == this->got_page_entries_.end())
5897         {
5898           Got_page_entry* entry2 = new Got_page_entry(*entry);
5899           this->got_page_entries_.insert(entry2);
5900           this->page_gotno_ += entry->num_pages;
5901         }
5902     }
5903 }
5904
5905 // Mips_output_data_got methods.
5906
5907 // Lay out the GOT.  Add local, global and TLS entries.  If GOT is
5908 // larger than 64K, create multi-GOT.
5909
5910 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5911 void
5912 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>::lay_out_got(Layout* layout,
5913     Symbol_table* symtab, const Input_objects* input_objects)
5914 {
5915   // Decide which symbols need to go in the global part of the GOT and
5916   // count the number of reloc-only GOT symbols.
5917   this->master_got_info_->count_got_symbols(symtab);
5918
5919   // Count the number of GOT entries.
5920   this->master_got_info_->count_got_entries();
5921
5922   unsigned int got_size = this->master_got_info_->got_size();
5923   if (got_size > Target_mips<size, big_endian>::MIPS_GOT_MAX_SIZE)
5924     this->lay_out_multi_got(layout, input_objects);
5925   else
5926     {
5927       // Record that all objects use single GOT.
5928       for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
5929            p != input_objects->relobj_end();
5930            ++p)
5931         {
5932           Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
5933             Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(*p);
5934           if (object->get_got_info() != NULL)
5935             object->set_got_info(this->master_got_info_);
5936         }
5937
5938       this->master_got_info_->add_local_entries(this->target_, layout);
5939       this->master_got_info_->add_global_entries(this->target_, layout,
5940                                                  /*not used*/-1U);
5941       this->master_got_info_->add_tls_entries(this->target_, layout);
5942     }
5943 }
5944
5945 // Create multi-GOT.  For every GOT, add local, global and TLS entries.
5946
5947 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5948 void
5949 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>::lay_out_multi_got(Layout* layout,
5950     const Input_objects* input_objects)
5951 {
5952   // Try to merge the GOTs of input objects together, as long as they
5953   // don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
5954   // to be the primary GOT.
5955   this->merge_gots(input_objects);
5956
5957   // Every symbol that is referenced in a dynamic relocation must be
5958   // present in the primary GOT.
5959   this->primary_got_->set_global_gotno(this->master_got_info_->global_gotno());
5960
5961   // Add GOT entries.
5962   unsigned int i = 0;
5963   unsigned int offset = 0;
5964   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = this->primary_got_;
5965   do
5966     {
5967       g->set_index(i);
5968       g->set_offset(offset);
5969
5970       g->add_local_entries(this->target_, layout);
5971       if (i == 0)
5972         g->add_global_entries(this->target_, layout,
5973                               (this->master_got_info_->global_gotno()
5974                                - this->master_got_info_->reloc_only_gotno()));
5975       else
5976         g->add_global_entries(this->target_, layout, /*not used*/-1U);
5977       g->add_tls_entries(this->target_, layout);
5978
5979       // Forbid global symbols in every non-primary GOT from having
5980       // lazy-binding stubs.
5981       if (i > 0)
5982         g->remove_lazy_stubs(this->target_);
5983
5984       ++i;
5985       offset += g->got_size();
5986       g = g->next();
5987     }
5988   while (g);
5989 }
5990
5991 // Attempt to merge GOTs of different input objects.  Try to use as much as
5992 // possible of the primary GOT, since it doesn't require explicit dynamic
5993 // relocations, but don't use objects that would reference global symbols
5994 // out of the addressable range.  Failing the primary GOT, attempt to merge
5995 // with the current GOT, or finish the current GOT and then make make the new
5996 // GOT current.
5997
5998 template<int size, bool big_endian>
5999 void
6000 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>::merge_gots(
6001     const Input_objects* input_objects)
6002 {
6003   gold_assert(this->primary_got_ == NULL);
6004   Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* current = NULL;
6005
6006   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
6007        p != input_objects->relobj_end();
6008        ++p)
6009     {
6010       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
6011         Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(*p);
6012
6013       Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* g = object->get_got_info();
6014       if (g == NULL)
6015         continue;
6016
6017       g->count_got_entries();
6018
6019       // Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries.
6020       unsigned int estimate = this->master_got_info_->page_gotno();
6021       if (estimate > g->page_gotno())
6022         estimate = g->page_gotno();
6023       estimate += g->local_gotno() + g->tls_gotno();
6024
6025       // We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals.  The globals
6026       // for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
6027       // sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
6028       // case.  This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs.
6029       estimate += (g->tls_gotno() > 0 ? this->master_got_info_->global_gotno()
6030                                       : g->global_gotno());
6031
6032       unsigned int max_count =
6033         Target_mips<size, big_endian>::MIPS_GOT_MAX_SIZE / (size/8) - 2;
6034       if (estimate <= max_count)
6035         {
6036           // If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
6037           // a starting point for the primary GOT.
6038           if (!this->primary_got_)
6039             {
6040               this->primary_got_ = g;
6041               continue;
6042             }
6043
6044           // Try merging with the primary GOT.
6045           if (this->merge_got_with(g, object, this->primary_got_))
6046             continue;
6047         }
6048
6049       // If we can merge with the last-created GOT, do it.
6050       if (current && this->merge_got_with(g, object, current))
6051         continue;
6052
6053       // Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT.  Don't check if it
6054       // fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
6055       // overflows anyway.
6056       g->set_next(current);
6057       current = g;
6058     }
6059
6060   // If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one.
6061   if (this->primary_got_ == NULL)
6062     this->primary_got_ = new Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>();
6063
6064   // Link primary GOT with secondary GOTs.
6065   this->primary_got_->set_next(current);
6066 }
6067
6068 // Consider merging FROM, which is OBJECT's GOT, into TO.  Return false if
6069 // this would lead to overflow, true if they were merged successfully.
6070
6071 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6072 bool
6073 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>::merge_got_with(
6074     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* from,
6075     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object,
6076     Mips_got_info<size, big_endian>* to)
6077 {
6078   // Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT.
6079   unsigned int estimate = this->master_got_info_->page_gotno();
6080   if (estimate >= from->page_gotno() + to->page_gotno())
6081     estimate = from->page_gotno() + to->page_gotno();
6082
6083   // Conservatively estimate how many local and TLS entries would be needed.
6084   estimate += from->local_gotno() + to->local_gotno();
6085   estimate += from->tls_gotno() + to->tls_gotno();
6086
6087   // If we're merging with the primary got, any TLS relocations will
6088   // come after the full set of global entries.  Otherwise estimate those
6089   // conservatively as well.
6090   if (to == this->primary_got_ && (from->tls_gotno() + to->tls_gotno()) > 0)
6091     estimate += this->master_got_info_->global_gotno();
6092   else
6093     estimate += from->global_gotno() + to->global_gotno();
6094
6095   // Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big.
6096   unsigned int max_count =
6097     Target_mips<size, big_endian>::MIPS_GOT_MAX_SIZE / (size/8) - 2;
6098   if (estimate > max_count)
6099     return false;
6100
6101   // Transfer the object's GOT information from FROM to TO.
6102   to->add_got_entries(from);
6103   to->add_got_page_entries(from);
6104
6105   // Record that OBJECT should use output GOT TO.
6106   object->set_got_info(to);
6107
6108   return true;
6109 }
6110
6111 // Write out the GOT.
6112
6113 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6114 void
6115 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
6116 {
6117   // Call parent to write out GOT.
6118   Output_data_got<size, big_endian>::do_write(of);
6119
6120   const off_t offset = this->offset();
6121   const section_size_type oview_size =
6122     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
6123   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
6124
6125   // Needed for fixing values of .got section.
6126   this->got_view_ = oview;
6127
6128   // Write lazy stub addresses.
6129   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::iterator
6130        p = this->master_got_info_->global_got_symbols().begin();
6131        p != this->master_got_info_->global_got_symbols().end();
6132        ++p)
6133     {
6134       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
6135       if (mips_sym->has_lazy_stub())
6136         {
6137           Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(
6138             oview + this->get_primary_got_offset(mips_sym));
6139           Valtype value =
6140             this->target_->mips_stubs_section()->stub_address(mips_sym);
6141           elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(wv, value);
6142         }
6143     }
6144
6145   // Add +1 to GGA_NONE nonzero MIPS16 and microMIPS entries.
6146   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::iterator
6147        p = this->master_got_info_->global_got_symbols().begin();
6148        p != this->master_got_info_->global_got_symbols().end();
6149        ++p)
6150     {
6151       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
6152       if (!this->multi_got()
6153           && (mips_sym->is_mips16() || mips_sym->is_micromips())
6154           && mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_NONE
6155           && mips_sym->has_got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD))
6156         {
6157           Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(
6158             oview + mips_sym->got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD));
6159           Valtype value = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(wv);
6160           if (value != 0)
6161             {
6162               value |= 1;
6163               elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(wv, value);
6164             }
6165         }
6166     }
6167
6168   if (!this->secondary_got_relocs_.empty())
6169     {
6170       // Fixup for the secondary GOT R_MIPS_REL32 relocs.  For global
6171       // secondary GOT entries with non-zero initial value copy the value
6172       // to the corresponding primary GOT entry, and set the secondary GOT
6173       // entry to zero.
6174       // TODO(sasa): This is workaround.  It needs to be investigated further.
6175
6176       for (size_t i = 0; i < this->secondary_got_relocs_.size(); ++i)
6177         {
6178           Static_reloc& reloc(this->secondary_got_relocs_[i]);
6179           if (reloc.symbol_is_global())
6180             {
6181               Mips_symbol<size>* gsym = reloc.symbol();
6182               gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
6183
6184               unsigned got_offset = reloc.got_offset();
6185               gold_assert(got_offset < oview_size);
6186
6187               // Find primary GOT entry.
6188               Valtype* wv_prim = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(
6189                 oview + this->get_primary_got_offset(gsym));
6190
6191               // Find secondary GOT entry.
6192               Valtype* wv_sec = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(oview + got_offset);
6193
6194               Valtype value = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(wv_sec);
6195               if (value != 0)
6196                 {
6197                   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(wv_prim, value);
6198                   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(wv_sec, 0);
6199                   gsym->set_applied_secondary_got_fixup();
6200                 }
6201             }
6202         }
6203
6204       of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
6205     }
6206
6207   // We are done if there is no fix up.
6208   if (this->static_relocs_.empty())
6209     return;
6210
6211   Output_segment* tls_segment = this->layout_->tls_segment();
6212   gold_assert(tls_segment != NULL);
6213
6214   for (size_t i = 0; i < this->static_relocs_.size(); ++i)
6215     {
6216       Static_reloc& reloc(this->static_relocs_[i]);
6217
6218       Mips_address value;
6219       if (!reloc.symbol_is_global())
6220         {
6221           Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object = reloc.relobj();
6222           const Symbol_value<size>* psymval =
6223             object->local_symbol(reloc.index());
6224
6225           // We are doing static linking.  Issue an error and skip this
6226           // relocation if the symbol is undefined or in a discarded_section.
6227           bool is_ordinary;
6228           unsigned int shndx = psymval->input_shndx(&is_ordinary);
6229           if ((shndx == elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF)
6230               || (is_ordinary
6231                   && shndx != elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF
6232                   && !object->is_section_included(shndx)
6233                   && !this->symbol_table_->is_section_folded(object, shndx)))
6234             {
6235               gold_error(_("undefined or discarded local symbol %u from "
6236                            " object %s in GOT"),
6237                          reloc.index(), reloc.relobj()->name().c_str());
6238               continue;
6239             }
6240
6241           value = psymval->value(object, 0);
6242         }
6243       else
6244         {
6245           const Mips_symbol<size>* gsym = reloc.symbol();
6246           gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
6247
6248           // We are doing static linking.  Issue an error and skip this
6249           // relocation if the symbol is undefined or in a discarded_section
6250           // unless it is a weakly_undefined symbol.
6251           if ((gsym->is_defined_in_discarded_section() || gsym->is_undefined())
6252               && !gsym->is_weak_undefined())
6253             {
6254               gold_error(_("undefined or discarded symbol %s in GOT"),
6255                          gsym->name());
6256               continue;
6257             }
6258
6259           if (!gsym->is_weak_undefined())
6260             value = gsym->value();
6261           else
6262             value = 0;
6263         }
6264
6265       unsigned got_offset = reloc.got_offset();
6266       gold_assert(got_offset < oview_size);
6267
6268       Valtype* wv = reinterpret_cast<Valtype*>(oview + got_offset);
6269       Valtype x;
6270
6271       switch (reloc.r_type())
6272         {
6273         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32:
6274         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64:
6275           x = value;
6276           break;
6277         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
6278         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
6279           x = value - elfcpp::DTP_OFFSET;
6280           break;
6281         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
6282         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
6283           x = value - elfcpp::TP_OFFSET;
6284           break;
6285         default:
6286           gold_unreachable();
6287           break;
6288         }
6289
6290       elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(wv, x);
6291     }
6292
6293   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
6294 }
6295
6296 // Mips_relobj methods.
6297
6298 // Count the local symbols.  The Mips backend needs to know if a symbol
6299 // is a MIPS16 or microMIPS function or not.  For global symbols, it is easy
6300 // because the Symbol object keeps the ELF symbol type and st_other field.
6301 // For local symbol it is harder because we cannot access this information.
6302 // So we override the do_count_local_symbol in parent and scan local symbols to
6303 // mark MIPS16 and microMIPS functions.  This is not the most efficient way but
6304 // I do not want to slow down other ports by calling a per symbol target hook
6305 // inside Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols.
6306
6307 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6308 void
6309 Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols(
6310     Stringpool_template<char>* pool,
6311     Stringpool_template<char>* dynpool)
6312 {
6313   // Ask parent to count the local symbols.
6314   Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>::do_count_local_symbols(pool, dynpool);
6315   const unsigned int loccount = this->local_symbol_count();
6316   if (loccount == 0)
6317     return;
6318
6319   // Initialize the mips16 and micromips function bit-vector.
6320   this->local_symbol_is_mips16_.resize(loccount, false);
6321   this->local_symbol_is_micromips_.resize(loccount, false);
6322
6323   // Read the symbol table section header.
6324   const unsigned int symtab_shndx = this->symtab_shndx();
6325   elfcpp::Shdr<size, big_endian>
6326     symtabshdr(this, this->elf_file()->section_header(symtab_shndx));
6327   gold_assert(symtabshdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_SYMTAB);
6328
6329   // Read the local symbols.
6330   const int sym_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::sym_size;
6331   gold_assert(loccount == symtabshdr.get_sh_info());
6332   off_t locsize = loccount * sym_size;
6333   const unsigned char* psyms = this->get_view(symtabshdr.get_sh_offset(),
6334                                               locsize, true, true);
6335
6336   // Loop over the local symbols and mark any MIPS16 or microMIPS local symbols.
6337
6338   // Skip the first dummy symbol.
6339   psyms += sym_size;
6340   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < loccount; ++i, psyms += sym_size)
6341     {
6342       elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian> sym(psyms);
6343       unsigned char st_other = sym.get_st_other();
6344       this->local_symbol_is_mips16_[i] = elfcpp::elf_st_is_mips16(st_other);
6345       this->local_symbol_is_micromips_[i] =
6346         elfcpp::elf_st_is_micromips(st_other);
6347     }
6348 }
6349
6350 // Read the symbol information.
6351
6352 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6353 void
6354 Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::do_read_symbols(Read_symbols_data* sd)
6355 {
6356   // Call parent class to read symbol information.
6357   this->base_read_symbols(sd);
6358
6359   // Read processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
6360   const unsigned char* pehdr = this->get_view(elfcpp::file_header_offset,
6361                                             elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::ehdr_size,
6362                                             true, false);
6363   elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian> ehdr(pehdr);
6364   this->processor_specific_flags_ = ehdr.get_e_flags();
6365
6366   // Get the section names.
6367   const unsigned char* pnamesu = sd->section_names->data();
6368   const char* pnames = reinterpret_cast<const char*>(pnamesu);
6369
6370   // Initialize the mips16 stub section bit-vectors.
6371   this->section_is_mips16_fn_stub_.resize(this->shnum(), false);
6372   this->section_is_mips16_call_stub_.resize(this->shnum(), false);
6373   this->section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_.resize(this->shnum(), false);
6374
6375   const size_t shdr_size = elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::shdr_size;
6376   const unsigned char* pshdrs = sd->section_headers->data();
6377   const unsigned char* ps = pshdrs + shdr_size;
6378   for (unsigned int i = 1; i < this->shnum(); ++i, ps += shdr_size)
6379     {
6380       elfcpp::Shdr<size, big_endian> shdr(ps);
6381
6382       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
6383         {
6384           // Read the gp value that was used to create this object.  We need the
6385           // gp value while processing relocs.  The .reginfo section is not used
6386           // in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI.
6387           section_offset_type section_offset = shdr.get_sh_offset();
6388           section_size_type section_size =
6389             convert_to_section_size_type(shdr.get_sh_size());
6390           const unsigned char* view =
6391              this->get_view(section_offset, section_size, true, false);
6392
6393           this->gp_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view + 20);
6394
6395           // Read the rest of .reginfo.
6396           this->gprmask_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view);
6397           this->cprmask1_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view + 4);
6398           this->cprmask2_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view + 8);
6399           this->cprmask3_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view + 12);
6400           this->cprmask4_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view + 16);
6401         }
6402
6403       // In the 64-bit ABI, .MIPS.options section holds register information.
6404       // A SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section contains a series of options, each of which
6405       // starts with this header:
6406       //
6407       // typedef struct
6408       // {
6409       //   // Type of option.
6410       //   unsigned char kind[1];
6411       //   // Size of option descriptor, including header.
6412       //   unsigned char size[1];
6413       //   // Section index of affected section, or 0 for global option.
6414       //   unsigned char section[2];
6415       //   // Information specific to this kind of option.
6416       //   unsigned char info[4];
6417       // };
6418       //
6419       // For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and set
6420       // the gp value based on what we find.  We may see both SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
6421       // and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case, they should agree.
6422
6423       if (shdr.get_sh_type() == elfcpp::SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
6424         {
6425           section_offset_type section_offset = shdr.get_sh_offset();
6426           section_size_type section_size =
6427             convert_to_section_size_type(shdr.get_sh_size());
6428           const unsigned char* view =
6429              this->get_view(section_offset, section_size, true, false);
6430           const unsigned char* end = view + section_size;
6431
6432           while (view + 8 <= end)
6433             {
6434               unsigned char kind = elfcpp::Swap<8, big_endian>::readval(view);
6435               unsigned char sz = elfcpp::Swap<8, big_endian>::readval(view + 1);
6436               if (sz < 8)
6437                 {
6438                   gold_error(_("%s: Warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller "
6439                                "than its header"),
6440                              this->name().c_str(),
6441                              this->mips_elf_options_section_name(), sz);
6442                   break;
6443                 }
6444
6445               if (this->is_n64() && kind == elfcpp::ODK_REGINFO)
6446                 {
6447                   // In the 64 bit ABI, an ODK_REGINFO option is the following
6448                   // structure.  The info field of the options header is not
6449                   // used.
6450                   //
6451                   // typedef struct
6452                   // {
6453                   //   // Mask of general purpose registers used.
6454                   //   unsigned char ri_gprmask[4];
6455                   //   // Padding.
6456                   //   unsigned char ri_pad[4];
6457                   //   // Mask of co-processor registers used.
6458                   //   unsigned char ri_cprmask[4][4];
6459                   //   // GP register value for this object file.
6460                   //   unsigned char ri_gp_value[8];
6461                   // };
6462
6463                   this->gp_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view
6464                                                                       + 32);
6465                 }
6466               else if (kind == elfcpp::ODK_REGINFO)
6467                 {
6468                   // In the 32 bit ABI, an ODK_REGINFO option is the following
6469                   // structure.  The info field of the options header is not
6470                   // used.  The same structure is used in .reginfo section.
6471                   //
6472                   // typedef struct
6473                   // {
6474                   //   unsigned char ri_gprmask[4];
6475                   //   unsigned char ri_cprmask[4][4];
6476                   //   unsigned char ri_gp_value[4];
6477                   // };
6478
6479                   this->gp_ = elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::readval(view
6480                                                                       + 28);
6481                 }
6482               view += sz;
6483             }
6484         }
6485
6486       const char* name = pnames + shdr.get_sh_name();
6487       this->section_is_mips16_fn_stub_[i] = is_prefix_of(".mips16.fn", name);
6488       this->section_is_mips16_call_stub_[i] =
6489         is_prefix_of(".mips16.call.", name);
6490       this->section_is_mips16_call_fp_stub_[i] =
6491         is_prefix_of(".mips16.call.fp.", name);
6492
6493       if (strcmp(name, ".pdr") == 0)
6494         {
6495           gold_assert(this->pdr_shndx_ == -1U);
6496           this->pdr_shndx_ = i;
6497         }
6498     }
6499 }
6500
6501 // Discard MIPS16 stub secions that are not needed.
6502
6503 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6504 void
6505 Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::discard_mips16_stub_sections(Symbol_table* symtab)
6506 {
6507   for (typename Mips16_stubs_int_map::const_iterator
6508        it = this->mips16_stub_sections_.begin();
6509        it != this->mips16_stub_sections_.end(); ++it)
6510     {
6511       Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* stub_section = it->second;
6512       if (!stub_section->is_target_found())
6513         {
6514           gold_error(_("no relocation found in mips16 stub section '%s'"),
6515                      stub_section->object()
6516                        ->section_name(stub_section->shndx()).c_str());
6517         }
6518
6519       bool discard = false;
6520       if (stub_section->is_for_local_function())
6521         {
6522           if (stub_section->is_fn_stub())
6523             {
6524               // This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only
6525               // be needed if there is some relocation in this object,
6526               // other than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this
6527               // symbol.
6528               if (!this->has_local_non_16bit_call_relocs(stub_section->r_sym()))
6529                 discard = true;
6530               else
6531                 this->add_local_mips16_fn_stub(stub_section);
6532             }
6533           else
6534             {
6535               // This stub is for a local symbol.  This stub will only
6536               // be needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in
6537               // this object that refers to this symbol.
6538               gold_assert(stub_section->is_call_stub()
6539                           || stub_section->is_call_fp_stub());
6540               if (!this->has_local_16bit_call_relocs(stub_section->r_sym()))
6541                 discard = true;
6542               else
6543                 this->add_local_mips16_call_stub(stub_section);
6544             }
6545         }
6546       else
6547         {
6548           Mips_symbol<size>* gsym = stub_section->gsym();
6549           if (stub_section->is_fn_stub())
6550             {
6551               if (gsym->has_mips16_fn_stub())
6552                 // We already have a stub for this function.
6553                 discard = true;
6554               else
6555                 {
6556                   gsym->set_mips16_fn_stub(stub_section);
6557                   if (gsym->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab))
6558                     {
6559                       // If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the
6560                       // dynamic symbol must refer to the stub, since only
6561                       // the stub uses the standard calling conventions.
6562                       gsym->set_need_fn_stub();
6563                       if (gsym->is_from_dynobj())
6564                         gsym->set_needs_dynsym_value();
6565                     }
6566                 }
6567               if (!gsym->need_fn_stub())
6568                 discard = true;
6569             }
6570           else if (stub_section->is_call_stub())
6571             {
6572               if (gsym->is_mips16())
6573                 // We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit
6574                 // function, so calls from other 16 bit functions are
6575                 // OK.
6576                 discard = true;
6577               else if (gsym->has_mips16_call_stub())
6578                 // We already have a stub for this function.
6579                 discard = true;
6580               else
6581                 gsym->set_mips16_call_stub(stub_section);
6582             }
6583           else
6584             {
6585               gold_assert(stub_section->is_call_fp_stub());
6586               if (gsym->is_mips16())
6587                 // We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit
6588                 // function, so calls from other 16 bit functions are
6589                 // OK.
6590                 discard = true;
6591               else if (gsym->has_mips16_call_fp_stub())
6592                 // We already have a stub for this function.
6593                 discard = true;
6594               else
6595                 gsym->set_mips16_call_fp_stub(stub_section);
6596             }
6597         }
6598       if (discard)
6599         this->set_output_section(stub_section->shndx(), NULL);
6600    }
6601 }
6602
6603 // Mips_output_data_la25_stub methods.
6604
6605 // Template for standard LA25 stub.
6606 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6607 const uint32_t
6608 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>::la25_stub_entry[] =
6609 {
6610   0x3c190000,           // lui $25,%hi(func)
6611   0x08000000,           // j func
6612   0x27390000,           // add $25,$25,%lo(func)
6613   0x00000000            // nop
6614 };
6615
6616 // Template for microMIPS LA25 stub.
6617 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6618 const uint32_t
6619 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>::la25_stub_micromips_entry[] =
6620 {
6621   0x41b9, 0x0000,       // lui t9,%hi(func)
6622   0xd400, 0x0000,       // j func
6623   0x3339, 0x0000,       // addiu t9,t9,%lo(func)
6624   0x0000, 0x0000        // nop
6625 };
6626
6627 // Create la25 stub for a symbol.
6628
6629 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6630 void
6631 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>::create_la25_stub(
6632     Symbol_table* symtab, Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
6633     Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
6634 {
6635   if (!gsym->has_la25_stub())
6636     {
6637       gsym->set_la25_stub_offset(this->symbols_.size() * 16);
6638       this->symbols_.insert(gsym);
6639       this->create_stub_symbol(gsym, symtab, target, 16);
6640     }
6641 }
6642
6643 // Create a symbol for SYM stub's value and size, to help make the disassembly
6644 // easier to read.
6645
6646 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6647 void
6648 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>::create_stub_symbol(
6649     Mips_symbol<size>* sym, Symbol_table* symtab,
6650     Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target, uint64_t symsize)
6651 {
6652   std::string name(".pic.");
6653   name += sym->name();
6654
6655   unsigned int offset = sym->la25_stub_offset();
6656   if (sym->is_micromips())
6657     offset |= 1;
6658
6659   // Make it a local function.
6660   Symbol* new_sym = symtab->define_in_output_data(name.c_str(), NULL,
6661                                       Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
6662                                       target->la25_stub_section(),
6663                                       offset, symsize, elfcpp::STT_FUNC,
6664                                       elfcpp::STB_LOCAL,
6665                                       elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT, 0,
6666                                       false, false);
6667   new_sym->set_is_forced_local();
6668 }
6669
6670 // Write out la25 stubs.  This uses the hand-coded instructions above,
6671 // and adjusts them as needed.
6672
6673 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6674 void
6675 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
6676 {
6677   const off_t offset = this->offset();
6678   const section_size_type oview_size =
6679     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
6680   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
6681
6682   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::iterator
6683        p = this->symbols_.begin();
6684        p != this->symbols_.end();
6685        ++p)
6686     {
6687       Mips_symbol<size>* sym = *p;
6688       unsigned char* pov = oview + sym->la25_stub_offset();
6689
6690       Mips_address target = sym->value();
6691       if (!sym->is_micromips())
6692         {
6693           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
6694               la25_stub_entry[0] | (((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff));
6695           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
6696               la25_stub_entry[1] | ((target >> 2) & 0x3ffffff));
6697           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8,
6698               la25_stub_entry[2] | (target & 0xffff));
6699           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 12, la25_stub_entry[3]);
6700         }
6701       else
6702         {
6703           target |= 1;
6704           // First stub instruction.  Paste high 16-bits of the target.
6705           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
6706                                                  la25_stub_micromips_entry[0]);
6707           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2,
6708               ((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff);
6709           // Second stub instruction.  Paste low 26-bits of the target, shifted
6710           // right by 1.
6711           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
6712               la25_stub_micromips_entry[2] | ((target >> 17) & 0x3ff));
6713           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 6,
6714               la25_stub_micromips_entry[3] | ((target >> 1) & 0xffff));
6715           // Third stub instruction.  Paste low 16-bits of the target.
6716           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8,
6717                                                  la25_stub_micromips_entry[4]);
6718           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 10, target & 0xffff);
6719           // Fourth stub instruction.
6720           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 12,
6721                                                  la25_stub_micromips_entry[6]);
6722           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 14,
6723                                                  la25_stub_micromips_entry[7]);
6724         }
6725     }
6726
6727   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
6728 }
6729
6730 // Mips_output_data_plt methods.
6731
6732 // The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable.
6733 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6734 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::plt0_entry_o32[] =
6735 {
6736   0x3c1c0000,         // lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0])
6737   0x8f990000,         // lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28)
6738   0x279c0000,         // addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])
6739   0x031cc023,         // subu $24, $24, $28
6740   0x03e07825,         // or $15, $31, zero
6741   0x0018c082,         // srl $24, $24, 2
6742   0x0320f809,         // jalr $25
6743   0x2718fffe          // subu $24, $24, 2
6744 };
6745
6746 // The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable.  Different
6747 // because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14) instead.
6748 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6749 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::plt0_entry_n32[] =
6750 {
6751   0x3c0e0000,         // lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0])
6752   0x8dd90000,         // lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14)
6753   0x25ce0000,         // addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])
6754   0x030ec023,         // subu $24, $24, $14
6755   0x03e07825,         // or $15, $31, zero
6756   0x0018c082,         // srl $24, $24, 2
6757   0x0320f809,         // jalr $25
6758   0x2718fffe          // subu $24, $24, 2
6759 };
6760
6761 // The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable.  Different
6762 // from N32 because of the increased size of GOT entries.
6763 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6764 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::plt0_entry_n64[] =
6765 {
6766   0x3c0e0000,         // lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0])
6767   0xddd90000,         // ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14)
6768   0x25ce0000,         // addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])
6769   0x030ec023,         // subu $24, $24, $14
6770   0x03e07825,         // or $15, $31, zero
6771   0x0018c0c2,         // srl $24, $24, 3
6772   0x0320f809,         // jalr $25
6773   0x2718fffe          // subu $24, $24, 2
6774 };
6775
6776 // The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable.
6777 // We rely on v0 ($2) rather than t8 ($24) to contain the address
6778 // of the GOTPLT entry handled, so this stub may only be used when
6779 // all the subsequent PLT entries are microMIPS code too.
6780 //
6781 // The trailing NOP is for alignment and correct disassembly only.
6782 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6783 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::
6784 plt0_entry_micromips_o32[] =
6785 {
6786   0x7980, 0x0000,      // addiupc $3, (&GOTPLT[0]) - .
6787   0xff23, 0x0000,      // lw $25, 0($3)
6788   0x0535,              // subu $2, $2, $3
6789   0x2525,              // srl $2, $2, 2
6790   0x3302, 0xfffe,      // subu $24, $2, 2
6791   0x0dff,              // move $15, $31
6792   0x45f9,              // jalrs $25
6793   0x0f83,              // move $28, $3
6794   0x0c00               // nop
6795 };
6796
6797 // The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable
6798 // in the insn32 mode.
6799 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6800 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::
6801 plt0_entry_micromips32_o32[] =
6802 {
6803   0x41bc, 0x0000,      // lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0])
6804   0xff3c, 0x0000,      // lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28)
6805   0x339c, 0x0000,      // addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])
6806   0x0398, 0xc1d0,      // subu $24, $24, $28
6807   0x001f, 0x7a90,      // or $15, $31, zero
6808   0x0318, 0x1040,      // srl $24, $24, 2
6809   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,      // jalr $25
6810   0x3318, 0xfffe       // subu $24, $24, 2
6811 };
6812
6813 // The format of subsequent standard entries in the PLT.
6814 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6815 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::plt_entry[] =
6816 {
6817   0x3c0f0000,           // lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry)
6818   0x01f90000,           // l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15)
6819   0x03200008,           // jr $25
6820   0x25f80000            // addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry)
6821 };
6822
6823 // The format of subsequent MIPS16 o32 PLT entries.  We use v1 ($3) as a
6824 // temporary because t8 ($24) and t9 ($25) are not directly addressable.
6825 // Note that this differs from the GNU ld which uses both v0 ($2) and v1 ($3).
6826 // We cannot use v0 because MIPS16 call stubs from the CS toolchain expect
6827 // target function address in register v0.
6828 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6829 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::plt_entry_mips16_o32[] =
6830 {
6831   0xb303,              // lw $3, 12($pc)
6832   0x651b,              // move $24, $3
6833   0x9b60,              // lw $3, 0($3)
6834   0xeb00,              // jr $3
6835   0x653b,              // move $25, $3
6836   0x6500,              // nop
6837   0x0000, 0x0000       // .word (.got.plt entry)
6838 };
6839
6840 // The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries.  We use v0 ($2)
6841 // as a temporary because t8 ($24) is not addressable with ADDIUPC.
6842 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6843 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::
6844 plt_entry_micromips_o32[] =
6845 {
6846   0x7900, 0x0000,      // addiupc $2, (.got.plt entry) - .
6847   0xff22, 0x0000,      // lw $25, 0($2)
6848   0x4599,              // jr $25
6849   0x0f02               // move $24, $2
6850 };
6851
6852 // The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries in the insn32 mode.
6853 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6854 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::
6855 plt_entry_micromips32_o32[] =
6856 {
6857   0x41af, 0x0000,      // lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry)
6858   0xff2f, 0x0000,      // lw $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15)
6859   0x0019, 0x0f3c,      // jr $25
6860   0x330f, 0x0000       // addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry)
6861 };
6862
6863 // Add an entry to the PLT for a symbol referenced by r_type relocation.
6864
6865 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6866 void
6867 Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::add_entry(Mips_symbol<size>* gsym,
6868                                                   unsigned int r_type)
6869 {
6870   gold_assert(!gsym->has_plt_offset());
6871
6872   // Final PLT offset for a symbol will be set in method set_plt_offsets().
6873   gsym->set_plt_offset(this->entry_count() * sizeof(plt_entry)
6874                        + sizeof(plt0_entry_o32));
6875   this->symbols_.push_back(gsym);
6876
6877   // Record whether the relocation requires a standard MIPS
6878   // or a compressed code entry.
6879   if (jal_reloc(r_type))
6880    {
6881      if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_26)
6882        gsym->set_needs_mips_plt(true);
6883      else
6884        gsym->set_needs_comp_plt(true);
6885    }
6886
6887   section_offset_type got_offset = this->got_plt_->current_data_size();
6888
6889   // Every PLT entry needs a GOT entry which points back to the PLT
6890   // entry (this will be changed by the dynamic linker, normally
6891   // lazily when the function is called).
6892   this->got_plt_->set_current_data_size(got_offset + size/8);
6893
6894   gsym->set_needs_dynsym_entry();
6895   this->rel_->add_global(gsym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT, this->got_plt_,
6896                          got_offset);
6897 }
6898
6899 // Set final PLT offsets.  For each symbol, determine whether standard or
6900 // compressed (MIPS16 or microMIPS) PLT entry is used.
6901
6902 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6903 void
6904 Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::set_plt_offsets()
6905 {
6906   // The sizes of individual PLT entries.
6907   unsigned int plt_mips_entry_size = this->standard_plt_entry_size();
6908   unsigned int plt_comp_entry_size = (!this->target_->is_output_newabi()
6909                                       ? this->compressed_plt_entry_size() : 0);
6910
6911   for (typename std::vector<Mips_symbol<size>*>::const_iterator
6912        p = this->symbols_.begin(); p != this->symbols_.end(); ++p)
6913     {
6914       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
6915
6916       // There are no defined MIPS16 or microMIPS PLT entries for n32 or n64,
6917       // so always use a standard entry there.
6918       //
6919       // If the symbol has a MIPS16 call stub and gets a PLT entry, then
6920       // all MIPS16 calls will go via that stub, and there is no benefit
6921       // to having a MIPS16 entry.  And in the case of call_stub a
6922       // standard entry actually has to be used as the stub ends with a J
6923       // instruction.
6924       if (this->target_->is_output_newabi()
6925           || mips_sym->has_mips16_call_stub()
6926           || mips_sym->has_mips16_call_fp_stub())
6927         {
6928           mips_sym->set_needs_mips_plt(true);
6929           mips_sym->set_needs_comp_plt(false);
6930         }
6931
6932       // Otherwise, if there are no direct calls to the function, we
6933       // have a free choice of whether to use standard or compressed
6934       // entries.  Prefer microMIPS entries if the object is known to
6935       // contain microMIPS code, so that it becomes possible to create
6936       // pure microMIPS binaries.  Prefer standard entries otherwise,
6937       // because MIPS16 ones are no smaller and are usually slower.
6938       if (!mips_sym->needs_mips_plt() && !mips_sym->needs_comp_plt())
6939         {
6940           if (this->target_->is_output_micromips())
6941             mips_sym->set_needs_comp_plt(true);
6942           else
6943             mips_sym->set_needs_mips_plt(true);
6944         }
6945
6946       if (mips_sym->needs_mips_plt())
6947         {
6948           mips_sym->set_mips_plt_offset(this->plt_mips_offset_);
6949           this->plt_mips_offset_ += plt_mips_entry_size;
6950         }
6951       if (mips_sym->needs_comp_plt())
6952         {
6953           mips_sym->set_comp_plt_offset(this->plt_comp_offset_);
6954           this->plt_comp_offset_ += plt_comp_entry_size;
6955         }
6956     }
6957
6958     // Figure out the size of the PLT header if we know that we are using it.
6959     if (this->plt_mips_offset_ + this->plt_comp_offset_ != 0)
6960       this->plt_header_size_ = this->get_plt_header_size();
6961 }
6962
6963 // Write out the PLT.  This uses the hand-coded instructions above,
6964 // and adjusts them as needed.
6965
6966 template<int size, bool big_endian>
6967 void
6968 Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
6969 {
6970   const off_t offset = this->offset();
6971   const section_size_type oview_size =
6972     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
6973   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
6974
6975   const off_t gotplt_file_offset = this->got_plt_->offset();
6976   const section_size_type gotplt_size =
6977     convert_to_section_size_type(this->got_plt_->data_size());
6978   unsigned char* const gotplt_view = of->get_output_view(gotplt_file_offset,
6979                                                          gotplt_size);
6980   unsigned char* pov = oview;
6981
6982   Mips_address plt_address = this->address();
6983
6984   // Calculate the address of .got.plt.
6985   Mips_address gotplt_addr = this->got_plt_->address();
6986   Mips_address gotplt_addr_high = ((gotplt_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
6987   Mips_address gotplt_addr_low = gotplt_addr & 0xffff;
6988
6989   // The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt's address can
6990   // not be loaded in two instructions.
6991   gold_assert((gotplt_addr & ~(Mips_address) 0x7fffffff) == 0
6992               || ~(gotplt_addr | 0x7fffffff) == 0);
6993
6994   // Write the PLT header.
6995   const uint32_t* plt0_entry = this->get_plt_header_entry();
6996   if (plt0_entry == plt0_entry_micromips_o32)
6997     {
6998       // Write microMIPS PLT header.
6999       gold_assert(gotplt_addr % 4 == 0);
7000
7001       Mips_address gotpc_offset = gotplt_addr - ((plt_address | 3) ^ 3);
7002
7003       // ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range.
7004       if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
7005        {
7006          gold_error(_(".got.plt offset of %ld from .plt beyond the range of "
7007                     "ADDIUPC"), (long)gotpc_offset);
7008          return;
7009        }
7010
7011       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
7012                  plt0_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f));
7013       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2,
7014                                              (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff);
7015       pov += 4;
7016       for (unsigned int i = 2;
7017            i < (sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips_o32)
7018                 / sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips_o32[0]));
7019            i++)
7020         {
7021           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, plt0_entry[i]);
7022           pov += 2;
7023         }
7024     }
7025   else if (plt0_entry == plt0_entry_micromips32_o32)
7026     {
7027       // Write microMIPS PLT header in insn32 mode.
7028       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, plt0_entry[0]);
7029       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, gotplt_addr_high);
7030       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, plt0_entry[2]);
7031       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 6, gotplt_addr_low);
7032       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8, plt0_entry[4]);
7033       elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 10, gotplt_addr_low);
7034       pov += 12;
7035       for (unsigned int i = 6;
7036            i < (sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips32_o32)
7037                 / sizeof(plt0_entry_micromips32_o32[0]));
7038            i++)
7039         {
7040           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, plt0_entry[i]);
7041           pov += 2;
7042         }
7043     }
7044   else
7045     {
7046       // Write standard PLT header.
7047       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
7048                                              plt0_entry[0] | gotplt_addr_high);
7049       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
7050                                              plt0_entry[1] | gotplt_addr_low);
7051       elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8,
7052                                              plt0_entry[2] | gotplt_addr_low);
7053       pov += 12;
7054       for (int i = 3; i < 8; i++)
7055         {
7056           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov, plt0_entry[i]);
7057           pov += 4;
7058         }
7059     }
7060
7061
7062   unsigned char* gotplt_pov = gotplt_view;
7063   unsigned int got_entry_size = size/8; // TODO(sasa): MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE
7064
7065   // The first two entries in .got.plt are reserved.
7066   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(gotplt_pov, 0);
7067   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(gotplt_pov + got_entry_size, 0);
7068
7069   unsigned int gotplt_offset = 2 * got_entry_size;
7070   gotplt_pov += 2 * got_entry_size;
7071
7072   // Calculate the address of the PLT header.
7073   Mips_address header_address = (plt_address
7074                                  + (this->is_plt_header_compressed() ? 1 : 0));
7075
7076   // Initialize compressed PLT area view.
7077   unsigned char* pov2 = pov + this->plt_mips_offset_;
7078
7079   // Write the PLT entries.
7080   for (typename std::vector<Mips_symbol<size>*>::const_iterator
7081        p = this->symbols_.begin();
7082        p != this->symbols_.end();
7083        ++p, gotplt_pov += got_entry_size, gotplt_offset += got_entry_size)
7084     {
7085       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
7086
7087       // Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry.
7088       uint32_t gotplt_entry_addr = (gotplt_addr + gotplt_offset);
7089       uint32_t gotplt_entry_addr_hi = (((gotplt_entry_addr + 0x8000) >> 16)
7090                                        & 0xffff);
7091       uint32_t gotplt_entry_addr_lo = gotplt_entry_addr & 0xffff;
7092
7093       // Initially point the .got.plt entry at the PLT header.
7094       if (this->target_->is_output_n64())
7095         elfcpp::Swap<64, big_endian>::writeval(gotplt_pov, header_address);
7096       else
7097         elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(gotplt_pov, header_address);
7098
7099       // Now handle the PLT itself.  First the standard entry.
7100       if (mips_sym->has_mips_plt_offset())
7101         {
7102           // Pick the load opcode (LW or LD).
7103           uint64_t load = this->target_->is_output_n64() ? 0xdc000000
7104                                                          : 0x8c000000;
7105
7106           // Fill in the PLT entry itself.
7107           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
7108               plt_entry[0] | gotplt_entry_addr_hi);
7109           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
7110               plt_entry[1] | gotplt_entry_addr_lo | load);
7111           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 8, plt_entry[2]);
7112           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 12,
7113               plt_entry[3] | gotplt_entry_addr_lo);
7114           pov += 16;
7115         }
7116
7117       // Now the compressed entry.  They come after any standard ones.
7118       if (mips_sym->has_comp_plt_offset())
7119         {
7120           if (!this->target_->is_output_micromips())
7121             {
7122               // Write MIPS16 PLT entry.
7123               const uint32_t* plt_entry = plt_entry_mips16_o32;
7124
7125               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2, plt_entry[0]);
7126               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 2, plt_entry[1]);
7127               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 4, plt_entry[2]);
7128               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 6, plt_entry[3]);
7129               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 8, plt_entry[4]);
7130               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 10, plt_entry[5]);
7131               elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 12,
7132                                                      gotplt_entry_addr);
7133               pov2 += 16;
7134             }
7135           else if (this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
7136             {
7137               // Write microMIPS PLT entry in insn32 mode.
7138               const uint32_t* plt_entry = plt_entry_micromips32_o32;
7139
7140               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2, plt_entry[0]);
7141               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 2,
7142                                                      gotplt_entry_addr_hi);
7143               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 4, plt_entry[2]);
7144               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 6,
7145                                                      gotplt_entry_addr_lo);
7146               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 8, plt_entry[4]);
7147               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 10, plt_entry[5]);
7148               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 12, plt_entry[6]);
7149               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 14,
7150                                                      gotplt_entry_addr_lo);
7151               pov2 += 16;
7152             }
7153           else
7154             {
7155               // Write microMIPS PLT entry.
7156               const uint32_t* plt_entry = plt_entry_micromips_o32;
7157
7158               gold_assert(gotplt_entry_addr % 4 == 0);
7159
7160               Mips_address loc_address = plt_address + pov2 - oview;
7161               int gotpc_offset = gotplt_entry_addr - ((loc_address | 3) ^ 3);
7162
7163               // ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range.
7164               if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
7165                 {
7166                   gold_error(_(".got.plt offset of %ld from .plt beyond the "
7167                              "range of ADDIUPC"), (long)gotpc_offset);
7168                   return;
7169                 }
7170
7171               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2,
7172                           plt_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f));
7173               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(
7174                   pov2 + 2, (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff);
7175               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 4, plt_entry[2]);
7176               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 6, plt_entry[3]);
7177               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 8, plt_entry[4]);
7178               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov2 + 10, plt_entry[5]);
7179               pov2 += 12;
7180             }
7181         }
7182     }
7183
7184   // Check the number of bytes written for standard entries.
7185   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(
7186       pov - oview - this->plt_header_size_) == this->plt_mips_offset_);
7187   // Check the number of bytes written for compressed entries.
7188   gold_assert((static_cast<section_size_type>(pov2 - pov)
7189                == this->plt_comp_offset_));
7190   // Check the total number of bytes written.
7191   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(pov2 - oview) == oview_size);
7192
7193   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(gotplt_pov - gotplt_view)
7194               == gotplt_size);
7195
7196   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
7197   of->write_output_view(gotplt_file_offset, gotplt_size, gotplt_view);
7198 }
7199
7200 // Mips_output_data_mips_stubs methods.
7201
7202 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is less than
7203 // 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, and ABI is not N64.
7204 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7205 const uint32_t
7206 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_normal_1[4] =
7207 {
7208   0x8f998010,         // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7209   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7210   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7211   0x24180000          // addiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7212 };
7213
7214 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is less than
7215 // 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, and ABI is N64.
7216 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7217 const uint32_t
7218 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_normal_1_n64[4] =
7219 {
7220   0xdf998010,         // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7221   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7222   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7223   0x64180000          // daddiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7224 };
7225
7226 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is less than
7227 // 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K, and ABI is not N64.
7228 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7229 const uint32_t
7230 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_normal_2[4] =
7231 {
7232   0x8f998010,         // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7233   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7234   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7235   0x34180000          // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7236 };
7237
7238 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is less than
7239 // 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K, and ABI is N64.
7240 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7241 const uint32_t
7242 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_normal_2_n64[4] =
7243 {
7244   0xdf998010,         // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7245   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7246   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7247   0x34180000          // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7248 };
7249
7250 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is greater than
7251 // 64K, and ABI is not N64.
7252 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7253 const uint32_t Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_big[5] =
7254 {
7255   0x8f998010,         // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7256   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7257   0x3c180000,         // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7258   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7259   0x37180000          // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7260 };
7261
7262 // The format of the lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is greater than
7263 // 64K, and ABI is N64.
7264 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7265 const uint32_t
7266 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_big_n64[5] =
7267 {
7268   0xdf998010,         // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7269   0x03e07825,         // or t7,ra,zero
7270   0x3c180000,         // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7271   0x0320f809,         // jalr t9,ra
7272   0x37180000          // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7273 };
7274
7275 // microMIPS stubs.
7276
7277 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7278 // less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, and ABI is not N64.
7279 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7280 const uint32_t
7281 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1[] =
7282 {
7283   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7284   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7285   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7286   0x3300, 0x0000      // addiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7287 };
7288
7289 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7290 // less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, and ABI is N64.
7291 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7292 const uint32_t
7293 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7294 lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1_n64[] =
7295 {
7296   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7297   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7298   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7299   0x5f00, 0x0000      // daddiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7300 };
7301
7302 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol
7303 // count is less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K,
7304 // and ABI is not N64.
7305 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7306 const uint32_t
7307 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2[] =
7308 {
7309   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7310   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7311   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7312   0x5300, 0x0000      // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7313 };
7314
7315 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol
7316 // count is less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K,
7317 // and ABI is N64.
7318 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7319 const uint32_t
7320 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7321 lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2_n64[] =
7322 {
7323   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7324   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7325   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7326   0x5300, 0x0000      // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7327 };
7328
7329 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7330 // greater than 64K, and ABI is not N64.
7331 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7332 const uint32_t
7333 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips_big[] =
7334 {
7335   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7336   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7337   0x41b8, 0x0000,     // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7338   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7339   0x5318, 0x0000      // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7340 };
7341
7342 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7343 // greater than 64K, and ABI is N64.
7344 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7345 const uint32_t
7346 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips_big_n64[] =
7347 {
7348   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7349   0x0dff,             // move t7,ra
7350   0x41b8, 0x0000,     // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7351   0x45d9,             // jalr t9
7352   0x5318, 0x0000      // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7353 };
7354
7355 // 32-bit microMIPS stubs.
7356
7357 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7358 // less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, ABI is not N64, and we
7359 // can use only 32-bit instructions.
7360 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7361 const uint32_t
7362 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7363 lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1[] =
7364 {
7365   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7366   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7367   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7368   0x3300, 0x0000      // addiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7369 };
7370
7371 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7372 // less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is less than 32K, ABI is N64, and we can
7373 // use only 32-bit instructions.
7374 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7375 const uint32_t
7376 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7377 lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1_n64[] =
7378 {
7379   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7380   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7381   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7382   0x5f00, 0x0000      // daddiu t8,zero,DYN_INDEX sign extended
7383 };
7384
7385 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol
7386 // count is less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K,
7387 // ABI is not N64, and we can use only 32-bit instructions.
7388 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7389 const uint32_t
7390 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7391 lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2[] =
7392 {
7393   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7394   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7395   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7396   0x5300, 0x0000      // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7397 };
7398
7399 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol
7400 // count is less than 64K, dynamic symbol index is between 32K and 64K,
7401 // ABI is N64, and we can use only 32-bit instructions.
7402 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7403 const uint32_t
7404 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::
7405 lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2_n64[] =
7406 {
7407   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7408   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7409   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7410   0x5300, 0x0000      // ori t8,zero,DYN_INDEX unsigned
7411 };
7412
7413 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7414 // greater than 64K, ABI is not N64, and we can use only 32-bit instructions.
7415 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7416 const uint32_t
7417 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips32_big[] =
7418 {
7419   0xff3c, 0x8010,     // lw t9,0x8010(gp)
7420   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7421   0x41b8, 0x0000,     // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7422   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7423   0x5318, 0x0000      // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7424 };
7425
7426 // The format of the microMIPS lazy binding stub when dynamic symbol count is
7427 // greater than 64K, ABI is N64, and we can use only 32-bit instructions.
7428 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7429 const uint32_t
7430 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::lazy_stub_micromips32_big_n64[] =
7431 {
7432   0xdf3c, 0x8010,     // ld t9,0x8010(gp)
7433   0x001f, 0x7a90,     // or t7,ra,zero
7434   0x41b8, 0x0000,     // lui t8,DYN_INDEX
7435   0x03f9, 0x0f3c,     // jalr ra,t9
7436   0x5318, 0x0000      // ori t8,t8,DYN_INDEX
7437 };
7438
7439 // Create entry for a symbol.
7440
7441 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7442 void
7443 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::make_entry(
7444     Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
7445 {
7446   if (!gsym->has_lazy_stub() && !gsym->has_plt_offset())
7447     {
7448       this->symbols_.insert(gsym);
7449       gsym->set_has_lazy_stub(true);
7450     }
7451 }
7452
7453 // Remove entry for a symbol.
7454
7455 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7456 void
7457 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::remove_entry(
7458     Mips_symbol<size>* gsym)
7459 {
7460   if (gsym->has_lazy_stub())
7461     {
7462       this->symbols_.erase(gsym);
7463       gsym->set_has_lazy_stub(false);
7464     }
7465 }
7466
7467 // Set stub offsets for symbols.  This method expects that the number of
7468 // entries in dynamic symbol table is set.
7469
7470 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7471 void
7472 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::set_lazy_stub_offsets()
7473 {
7474   gold_assert(this->dynsym_count_ != -1U);
7475
7476   if (this->stub_offsets_are_set_)
7477     return;
7478
7479   unsigned int stub_size = this->stub_size();
7480   unsigned int offset = 0;
7481   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::const_iterator
7482        p = this->symbols_.begin();
7483        p != this->symbols_.end();
7484        ++p, offset += stub_size)
7485     {
7486       Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = *p;
7487       mips_sym->set_lazy_stub_offset(offset);
7488     }
7489   this->stub_offsets_are_set_ = true;
7490 }
7491
7492 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7493 void
7494 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::set_needs_dynsym_value()
7495 {
7496   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::const_iterator
7497        p = this->symbols_.begin(); p != this->symbols_.end(); ++p)
7498     {
7499       Mips_symbol<size>* sym = *p;
7500       if (sym->is_from_dynobj())
7501         sym->set_needs_dynsym_value();
7502     }
7503 }
7504
7505 // Write out the .MIPS.stubs.  This uses the hand-coded instructions and
7506 // adjusts them as needed.
7507
7508 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7509 void
7510 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
7511 {
7512   const off_t offset = this->offset();
7513   const section_size_type oview_size =
7514     convert_to_section_size_type(this->data_size());
7515   unsigned char* const oview = of->get_output_view(offset, oview_size);
7516
7517   bool big_stub = this->dynsym_count_ > 0x10000;
7518
7519   unsigned char* pov = oview;
7520   for (typename Unordered_set<Mips_symbol<size>*>::const_iterator
7521        p = this->symbols_.begin(); p != this->symbols_.end(); ++p)
7522     {
7523       Mips_symbol<size>* sym = *p;
7524       const uint32_t* lazy_stub;
7525       bool n64 = this->target_->is_output_n64();
7526
7527       if (!this->target_->is_output_micromips())
7528         {
7529           // Write standard (non-microMIPS) stub.
7530           if (!big_stub)
7531             {
7532               if (sym->dynsym_index() & ~0x7fff)
7533                 // Dynsym index is between 32K and 64K.
7534                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_normal_2_n64 : lazy_stub_normal_2;
7535               else
7536                 // Dynsym index is less than 32K.
7537                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_normal_1_n64 : lazy_stub_normal_1;
7538             }
7539           else
7540             lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_big_n64 : lazy_stub_big;
7541
7542           unsigned int i = 0;
7543           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7544           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, lazy_stub[i + 1]);
7545           pov += 8;
7546
7547           i += 2;
7548           if (big_stub)
7549             {
7550               // LUI instruction of the big stub.  Paste high 16 bits of the
7551               // dynsym index.
7552               elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov,
7553                   lazy_stub[i] | ((sym->dynsym_index() >> 16) & 0x7fff));
7554               pov += 4;
7555               i += 1;
7556             }
7557           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7558           // Last stub instruction.  Paste low 16 bits of the dynsym index.
7559           elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
7560               lazy_stub[i + 1] | (sym->dynsym_index() & 0xffff));
7561           pov += 8;
7562         }
7563       else if (this->target_->use_32bit_micromips_instructions())
7564         {
7565           // Write microMIPS stub in insn32 mode.
7566           if (!big_stub)
7567             {
7568               if (sym->dynsym_index() & ~0x7fff)
7569                 // Dynsym index is between 32K and 64K.
7570                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2_n64
7571                                 : lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_2;
7572               else
7573                 // Dynsym index is less than 32K.
7574                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1_n64
7575                                 : lazy_stub_micromips32_normal_1;
7576             }
7577           else
7578             lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips32_big_n64
7579                             : lazy_stub_micromips32_big;
7580
7581           unsigned int i = 0;
7582           // First stub instruction.  We emit 32-bit microMIPS instructions by
7583           // emitting two 16-bit parts because on microMIPS the 16-bit part of
7584           // the instruction where the opcode is must always come first, for
7585           // both little and big endian.
7586           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7587           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, lazy_stub[i + 1]);
7588           // Second stub instruction.
7589           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, lazy_stub[i + 2]);
7590           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 6, lazy_stub[i + 3]);
7591           pov += 8;
7592           i += 4;
7593           if (big_stub)
7594             {
7595               // LUI instruction of the big stub.  Paste high 16 bits of the
7596               // dynsym index.
7597               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7598               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2,
7599                   (sym->dynsym_index() >> 16) & 0x7fff);
7600               pov += 4;
7601               i += 2;
7602             }
7603           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7604           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, lazy_stub[i + 1]);
7605           // Last stub instruction.  Paste low 16 bits of the dynsym index.
7606           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, lazy_stub[i + 2]);
7607           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 6,
7608               sym->dynsym_index() & 0xffff);
7609           pov += 8;
7610         }
7611       else
7612         {
7613           // Write microMIPS stub.
7614           if (!big_stub)
7615             {
7616               if (sym->dynsym_index() & ~0x7fff)
7617                 // Dynsym index is between 32K and 64K.
7618                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2_n64
7619                                 : lazy_stub_micromips_normal_2;
7620               else
7621                 // Dynsym index is less than 32K.
7622                 lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1_n64
7623                                 : lazy_stub_micromips_normal_1;
7624             }
7625           else
7626             lazy_stub = n64 ? lazy_stub_micromips_big_n64
7627                             : lazy_stub_micromips_big;
7628
7629           unsigned int i = 0;
7630           // First stub instruction.  We emit 32-bit microMIPS instructions by
7631           // emitting two 16-bit parts because on microMIPS the 16-bit part of
7632           // the instruction where the opcode is must always come first, for
7633           // both little and big endian.
7634           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7635           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, lazy_stub[i + 1]);
7636           // Second stub instruction.
7637           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4, lazy_stub[i + 2]);
7638           pov += 6;
7639           i += 3;
7640           if (big_stub)
7641             {
7642               // LUI instruction of the big stub.  Paste high 16 bits of the
7643               // dynsym index.
7644               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7645               elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2,
7646                   (sym->dynsym_index() >> 16) & 0x7fff);
7647               pov += 4;
7648               i += 2;
7649             }
7650           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov, lazy_stub[i]);
7651           // Last stub instruction.  Paste low 16 bits of the dynsym index.
7652           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 2, lazy_stub[i + 1]);
7653           elfcpp::Swap<16, big_endian>::writeval(pov + 4,
7654               sym->dynsym_index() & 0xffff);
7655           pov += 6;
7656         }
7657     }
7658
7659   // We always allocate 20 bytes for every stub, because final dynsym count is
7660   // not known in method do_finalize_sections.  There are 4 unused bytes per
7661   // stub if final dynsym count is less than 0x10000.
7662   unsigned int used = pov - oview;
7663   unsigned int unused = big_stub ? 0 : this->symbols_.size() * 4;
7664   gold_assert(static_cast<section_size_type>(used + unused) == oview_size);
7665
7666   // Fill the unused space with zeroes.
7667   // TODO(sasa): Can we strip unused bytes during the relaxation?
7668   if (unused > 0)
7669     memset(pov, 0, unused);
7670
7671   of->write_output_view(offset, oview_size, oview);
7672 }
7673
7674 // Mips_output_section_reginfo methods.
7675
7676 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7677 void
7678 Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>::do_write(Output_file* of)
7679 {
7680   off_t offset = this->offset();
7681   off_t data_size = this->data_size();
7682
7683   unsigned char* view = of->get_output_view(offset, data_size);
7684   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view, this->gprmask_);
7685   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view + 4, this->cprmask1_);
7686   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view + 8, this->cprmask2_);
7687   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view + 12, this->cprmask3_);
7688   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view + 16, this->cprmask4_);
7689   // Write the gp value.
7690   elfcpp::Swap<size, big_endian>::writeval(view + 20,
7691                                            this->target_->gp_value());
7692
7693   of->write_output_view(offset, data_size, view);
7694 }
7695
7696 // Mips_copy_relocs methods.
7697
7698 // Emit any saved relocs.
7699
7700 template<int sh_type, int size, bool big_endian>
7701 void
7702 Mips_copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>::emit_mips(
7703     Output_data_reloc<sh_type, true, size, big_endian>* reloc_section,
7704     Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
7705 {
7706   for (typename Copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>::
7707        Copy_reloc_entries::iterator p = this->entries_.begin();
7708        p != this->entries_.end();
7709        ++p)
7710     emit_entry(*p, reloc_section, symtab, layout, target);
7711
7712   // We no longer need the saved information.
7713   this->entries_.clear();
7714 }
7715
7716 // Emit the reloc if appropriate.
7717
7718 template<int sh_type, int size, bool big_endian>
7719 void
7720 Mips_copy_relocs<sh_type, size, big_endian>::emit_entry(
7721     Copy_reloc_entry& entry,
7722     Output_data_reloc<sh_type, true, size, big_endian>* reloc_section,
7723     Symbol_table* symtab, Layout* layout, Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target)
7724 {
7725   // If the symbol is no longer defined in a dynamic object, then we
7726   // emitted a COPY relocation, and we do not want to emit this
7727   // dynamic relocation.
7728   if (!entry.sym_->is_from_dynobj())
7729     return;
7730
7731   bool can_make_dynamic = (entry.reloc_type_ == elfcpp::R_MIPS_32
7732                            || entry.reloc_type_ == elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32
7733                            || entry.reloc_type_ == elfcpp::R_MIPS_64);
7734
7735   Mips_symbol<size>* sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(entry.sym_);
7736   if (can_make_dynamic && !sym->has_static_relocs())
7737     {
7738       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
7739         Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(entry.relobj_);
7740       target->got_section(symtab, layout)->record_global_got_symbol(
7741                           sym, object, entry.reloc_type_, true, false);
7742       if (!symbol_references_local(sym, sym->should_add_dynsym_entry(symtab)))
7743         target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_global(sym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32,
7744             entry.output_section_, entry.relobj_, entry.shndx_, entry.address_);
7745       else
7746         target->rel_dyn_section(layout)->add_symbolless_global_addend(
7747             sym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, entry.output_section_, entry.relobj_,
7748             entry.shndx_, entry.address_);
7749     }
7750   else
7751     this->make_copy_reloc(symtab, layout,
7752                           static_cast<Sized_symbol<size>*>(entry.sym_),
7753                           reloc_section);
7754 }
7755
7756 // Target_mips methods.
7757
7758 // Return the value to use for a dynamic symbol which requires special
7759 // treatment.  This is how we support equality comparisons of function
7760 // pointers across shared library boundaries, as described in the
7761 // processor specific ABI supplement.
7762
7763 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7764 uint64_t
7765 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_dynsym_value(const Symbol* gsym) const
7766 {
7767   uint64_t value = 0;
7768   const Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(gsym);
7769
7770   if (!mips_sym->has_lazy_stub())
7771     {
7772       if (mips_sym->has_plt_offset())
7773         {
7774           // We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
7775           // giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT.  Set the
7776           // value to the stub address if there are any relocations in the
7777           // binary where pointer equality matters.
7778           if (mips_sym->pointer_equality_needed())
7779             {
7780               // Prefer a standard MIPS PLT entry.
7781               if (mips_sym->has_mips_plt_offset())
7782                 value = this->plt_section()->mips_entry_address(mips_sym);
7783               else
7784                 value = this->plt_section()->comp_entry_address(mips_sym) + 1;
7785             }
7786           else
7787             value = 0;
7788         }
7789     }
7790   else
7791     {
7792       // First, set stub offsets for symbols.  This method expects that the
7793       // number of entries in dynamic symbol table is set.
7794       this->mips_stubs_section()->set_lazy_stub_offsets();
7795
7796       // The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
7797       // to reset the global offset table entry for this external
7798       // to its stub address when unlinking a shared object.
7799       value = this->mips_stubs_section()->stub_address(mips_sym);
7800     }
7801
7802   if (mips_sym->has_mips16_fn_stub())
7803     {
7804       // If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol must
7805       // refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard calling
7806       // conventions.
7807       value = mips_sym->template
7808               get_mips16_fn_stub<big_endian>()->output_address();
7809     }
7810
7811   return value;
7812 }
7813
7814 // Get the dynamic reloc section, creating it if necessary.  It's always
7815 // .rel.dyn, even for MIPS64.
7816
7817 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7818 typename Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Reloc_section*
7819 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::rel_dyn_section(Layout* layout)
7820 {
7821   if (this->rel_dyn_ == NULL)
7822     {
7823       gold_assert(layout != NULL);
7824       this->rel_dyn_ = new Reloc_section(parameters->options().combreloc());
7825       layout->add_output_section_data(".rel.dyn", elfcpp::SHT_REL,
7826                                       elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC, this->rel_dyn_,
7827                                       ORDER_DYNAMIC_RELOCS, false);
7828
7829       // First entry in .rel.dyn has to be null.
7830       // This is hack - we define dummy output data and set its address to 0,
7831       // and define absolute R_MIPS_NONE relocation with offset 0 against it.
7832       // This ensures that the entry is null.
7833       Output_data* od = new Output_data_zero_fill(0, 0);
7834       od->set_address(0);
7835       this->rel_dyn_->add_absolute(elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE, od, 0);
7836     }
7837   return this->rel_dyn_;
7838 }
7839
7840 // Get the GOT section, creating it if necessary.
7841
7842 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7843 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>*
7844 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::got_section(Symbol_table* symtab,
7845                                            Layout* layout)
7846 {
7847   if (this->got_ == NULL)
7848     {
7849       gold_assert(symtab != NULL && layout != NULL);
7850
7851       this->got_ = new Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>(this, symtab,
7852                                                               layout);
7853       layout->add_output_section_data(".got", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
7854                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC | elfcpp::SHF_WRITE |
7855                                       elfcpp::SHF_MIPS_GPREL),
7856                                       this->got_, ORDER_DATA, false);
7857
7858       // Define _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ at the start of the .got section.
7859       symtab->define_in_output_data("_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", NULL,
7860                                     Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
7861                                     this->got_,
7862                                     0, 0, elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
7863                                     elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL,
7864                                     elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT, 0,
7865                                     false, false);
7866     }
7867
7868   return this->got_;
7869 }
7870
7871 // Calculate value of _gp symbol.
7872
7873 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7874 void
7875 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::set_gp(Layout* layout, Symbol_table* symtab)
7876 {
7877   if (this->gp_ != NULL)
7878     return;
7879
7880   Output_data* section = layout->find_output_section(".got");
7881   if (section == NULL)
7882     {
7883       // If there is no .got section, gp should be based on .sdata.
7884       // TODO(sasa): This is probably not needed.  This was needed for older
7885       // MIPS architectures which accessed both GOT and .sdata section using
7886       // gp-relative addressing.  Modern Mips Linux ELF architectures don't
7887       // access .sdata using gp-relative addressing.
7888       for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator
7889            p = layout->section_list().begin();
7890            p != layout->section_list().end();
7891            ++p)
7892         {
7893           if (strcmp((*p)->name(), ".sdata") == 0)
7894             {
7895               section = *p;
7896               break;
7897             }
7898         }
7899     }
7900
7901   Sized_symbol<size>* gp =
7902     static_cast<Sized_symbol<size>*>(symtab->lookup("_gp"));
7903   if (gp != NULL)
7904     {
7905       if (gp->source() != Symbol::IS_CONSTANT && section != NULL)
7906         gp->init_output_data(gp->name(), NULL, section, MIPS_GP_OFFSET, 0,
7907                              elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
7908                              elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL,
7909                              elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT, 0,
7910                              false, false);
7911       this->gp_ = gp;
7912     }
7913   else if (section != NULL)
7914     {
7915       gp = static_cast<Sized_symbol<size>*>(symtab->define_in_output_data(
7916                                       "_gp", NULL, Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
7917                                       section, MIPS_GP_OFFSET, 0,
7918                                       elfcpp::STT_OBJECT,
7919                                       elfcpp::STB_GLOBAL,
7920                                       elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT,
7921                                       0, false, false));
7922       this->gp_ = gp;
7923     }
7924 }
7925
7926 // Set the dynamic symbol indexes.  INDEX is the index of the first
7927 // global dynamic symbol.  Pointers to the symbols are stored into the
7928 // vector SYMS.  The names are added to DYNPOOL.  This returns an
7929 // updated dynamic symbol index.
7930
7931 template<int size, bool big_endian>
7932 unsigned int
7933 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_set_dynsym_indexes(
7934     std::vector<Symbol*>* dyn_symbols, unsigned int index,
7935     std::vector<Symbol*>* syms, Stringpool* dynpool,
7936     Versions* versions, Symbol_table* symtab) const
7937 {
7938   std::vector<Symbol*> non_got_symbols;
7939   std::vector<Symbol*> got_symbols;
7940
7941   reorder_dyn_symbols<size, big_endian>(dyn_symbols, &non_got_symbols,
7942                                         &got_symbols);
7943
7944   for (std::vector<Symbol*>::iterator p = non_got_symbols.begin();
7945        p != non_got_symbols.end();
7946        ++p)
7947     {
7948       Symbol* sym = *p;
7949
7950       // Note that SYM may already have a dynamic symbol index, since
7951       // some symbols appear more than once in the symbol table, with
7952       // and without a version.
7953
7954       if (!sym->has_dynsym_index())
7955         {
7956           sym->set_dynsym_index(index);
7957           ++index;
7958           syms->push_back(sym);
7959           dynpool->add(sym->name(), false, NULL);
7960
7961           // Record any version information.
7962           if (sym->version() != NULL)
7963             versions->record_version(symtab, dynpool, sym);
7964
7965           // If the symbol is defined in a dynamic object and is
7966           // referenced in a regular object, then mark the dynamic
7967           // object as needed.  This is used to implement --as-needed.
7968           if (sym->is_from_dynobj() && sym->in_reg())
7969             sym->object()->set_is_needed();
7970         }
7971     }
7972
7973   for (std::vector<Symbol*>::iterator p = got_symbols.begin();
7974        p != got_symbols.end();
7975        ++p)
7976     {
7977       Symbol* sym = *p;
7978       if (!sym->has_dynsym_index())
7979         {
7980           // Record any version information.
7981           if (sym->version() != NULL)
7982             versions->record_version(symtab, dynpool, sym);
7983         }
7984     }
7985
7986   index = versions->finalize(symtab, index, syms);
7987
7988   int got_sym_count = 0;
7989   for (std::vector<Symbol*>::iterator p = got_symbols.begin();
7990        p != got_symbols.end();
7991        ++p)
7992     {
7993       Symbol* sym = *p;
7994
7995       if (!sym->has_dynsym_index())
7996         {
7997           ++got_sym_count;
7998           sym->set_dynsym_index(index);
7999           ++index;
8000           syms->push_back(sym);
8001           dynpool->add(sym->name(), false, NULL);
8002
8003           // If the symbol is defined in a dynamic object and is
8004           // referenced in a regular object, then mark the dynamic
8005           // object as needed.  This is used to implement --as-needed.
8006           if (sym->is_from_dynobj() && sym->in_reg())
8007             sym->object()->set_is_needed();
8008         }
8009     }
8010
8011   // Set index of the first symbol that has .got entry.
8012   this->got_->set_first_global_got_dynsym_index(
8013     got_sym_count > 0 ? index - got_sym_count : -1U);
8014
8015   if (this->mips_stubs_ != NULL)
8016     this->mips_stubs_->set_dynsym_count(index);
8017
8018   return index;
8019 }
8020
8021 // Create a PLT entry for a global symbol referenced by r_type relocation.
8022
8023 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8024 void
8025 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::make_plt_entry(Symbol_table* symtab,
8026                                               Layout* layout,
8027                                               Mips_symbol<size>* gsym,
8028                                               unsigned int r_type)
8029 {
8030   if (gsym->has_lazy_stub() || gsym->has_plt_offset())
8031     return;
8032
8033   if (this->plt_ == NULL)
8034     {
8035       // Create the GOT section first.
8036       this->got_section(symtab, layout);
8037
8038       this->got_plt_ = new Output_data_space(4, "** GOT PLT");
8039       layout->add_output_section_data(".got.plt", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
8040                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC | elfcpp::SHF_WRITE),
8041                                       this->got_plt_, ORDER_DATA, false);
8042
8043       // The first two entries are reserved.
8044       this->got_plt_->set_current_data_size(2 * size/8);
8045
8046       this->plt_ = new Mips_output_data_plt<size, big_endian>(layout,
8047                                                               this->got_plt_,
8048                                                               this);
8049       layout->add_output_section_data(".plt", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
8050                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC
8051                                        | elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR),
8052                                       this->plt_, ORDER_PLT, false);
8053     }
8054
8055   this->plt_->add_entry(gsym, r_type);
8056 }
8057
8058
8059 // Get the .MIPS.stubs section, creating it if necessary.
8060
8061 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8062 Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>*
8063 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::mips_stubs_section(Layout* layout)
8064 {
8065   if (this->mips_stubs_ == NULL)
8066     {
8067       this->mips_stubs_ =
8068         new Mips_output_data_mips_stubs<size, big_endian>(this);
8069       layout->add_output_section_data(".MIPS.stubs", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
8070                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC
8071                                        | elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR),
8072                                       this->mips_stubs_, ORDER_PLT, false);
8073     }
8074   return this->mips_stubs_;
8075 }
8076
8077 // Get the LA25 stub section, creating it if necessary.
8078
8079 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8080 Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>*
8081 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::la25_stub_section(Layout* layout)
8082 {
8083   if (this->la25_stub_ == NULL)
8084     {
8085       this->la25_stub_ = new Mips_output_data_la25_stub<size, big_endian>();
8086       layout->add_output_section_data(".text", elfcpp::SHT_PROGBITS,
8087                                       (elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC
8088                                        | elfcpp::SHF_EXECINSTR),
8089                                       this->la25_stub_, ORDER_TEXT, false);
8090     }
8091   return this->la25_stub_;
8092 }
8093
8094 // Process the relocations to determine unreferenced sections for
8095 // garbage collection.
8096
8097 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8098 void
8099 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::gc_process_relocs(
8100                         Symbol_table* symtab,
8101                         Layout* layout,
8102                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
8103                         unsigned int data_shndx,
8104                         unsigned int sh_type,
8105                         const unsigned char* prelocs,
8106                         size_t reloc_count,
8107                         Output_section* output_section,
8108                         bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8109                         size_t local_symbol_count,
8110                         const unsigned char* plocal_symbols)
8111 {
8112   typedef Target_mips<size, big_endian> Mips;
8113
8114   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
8115     {
8116       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
8117           Classify_reloc;
8118
8119       gold::gc_process_relocs<size, big_endian, Mips, Scan, Classify_reloc>(
8120         symtab,
8121         layout,
8122         this,
8123         object,
8124         data_shndx,
8125         prelocs,
8126         reloc_count,
8127         output_section,
8128         needs_special_offset_handling,
8129         local_symbol_count,
8130         plocal_symbols);
8131     }
8132   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
8133     {
8134       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
8135           Classify_reloc;
8136
8137       gold::gc_process_relocs<size, big_endian, Mips, Scan, Classify_reloc>(
8138         symtab,
8139         layout,
8140         this,
8141         object,
8142         data_shndx,
8143         prelocs,
8144         reloc_count,
8145         output_section,
8146         needs_special_offset_handling,
8147         local_symbol_count,
8148         plocal_symbols);
8149     }
8150   else
8151     gold_unreachable();
8152 }
8153
8154 // Scan relocations for a section.
8155
8156 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8157 void
8158 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::scan_relocs(
8159                         Symbol_table* symtab,
8160                         Layout* layout,
8161                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
8162                         unsigned int data_shndx,
8163                         unsigned int sh_type,
8164                         const unsigned char* prelocs,
8165                         size_t reloc_count,
8166                         Output_section* output_section,
8167                         bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8168                         size_t local_symbol_count,
8169                         const unsigned char* plocal_symbols)
8170 {
8171   typedef Target_mips<size, big_endian> Mips;
8172
8173   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
8174     {
8175       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
8176           Classify_reloc;
8177
8178       gold::scan_relocs<size, big_endian, Mips, Scan, Classify_reloc>(
8179         symtab,
8180         layout,
8181         this,
8182         object,
8183         data_shndx,
8184         prelocs,
8185         reloc_count,
8186         output_section,
8187         needs_special_offset_handling,
8188         local_symbol_count,
8189         plocal_symbols);
8190     }
8191   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
8192     {
8193       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
8194           Classify_reloc;
8195
8196       gold::scan_relocs<size, big_endian, Mips, Scan, Classify_reloc>(
8197         symtab,
8198         layout,
8199         this,
8200         object,
8201         data_shndx,
8202         prelocs,
8203         reloc_count,
8204         output_section,
8205         needs_special_offset_handling,
8206         local_symbol_count,
8207         plocal_symbols);
8208     }
8209 }
8210
8211 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8212 bool
8213 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::mips_32bit_flags(elfcpp::Elf_Word flags)
8214 {
8215   return ((flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
8216           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_O32
8217           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
8218           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_1
8219           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_2
8220           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32
8221           || (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH) == elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2);
8222 }
8223
8224 // Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value.
8225 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8226 unsigned int
8227 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::elf_mips_mach(elfcpp::Elf_Word flags)
8228 {
8229   switch (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH)
8230     {
8231     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
8232       return mach_mips3900;
8233
8234     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
8235       return mach_mips4010;
8236
8237     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
8238       return mach_mips4100;
8239
8240     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
8241       return mach_mips4111;
8242
8243     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
8244       return mach_mips4120;
8245
8246     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
8247       return mach_mips4650;
8248
8249     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
8250       return mach_mips5400;
8251
8252     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
8253       return mach_mips5500;
8254
8255     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
8256       return mach_mips9000;
8257
8258     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
8259       return mach_mips_sb1;
8260
8261     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
8262       return mach_mips_loongson_2e;
8263
8264     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
8265       return mach_mips_loongson_2f;
8266
8267     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A:
8268       return mach_mips_loongson_3a;
8269
8270     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2:
8271       return mach_mips_octeon2;
8272
8273     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
8274       return mach_mips_octeon;
8275
8276     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
8277       return mach_mips_xlr;
8278
8279     default:
8280       switch (flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH)
8281         {
8282         default:
8283         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
8284           return mach_mips3000;
8285
8286         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
8287           return mach_mips6000;
8288
8289         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
8290           return mach_mips4000;
8291
8292         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
8293           return mach_mips8000;
8294
8295         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
8296           return mach_mips5;
8297
8298         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
8299           return mach_mipsisa32;
8300
8301         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
8302           return mach_mipsisa64;
8303
8304         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
8305           return mach_mipsisa32r2;
8306
8307         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
8308           return mach_mipsisa64r2;
8309         }
8310     }
8311
8312   return 0;
8313 }
8314
8315 // Check whether machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE.
8316 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8317 bool
8318 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::mips_mach_extends(unsigned int base,
8319                                                  unsigned int extension)
8320 {
8321   if (extension == base)
8322     return true;
8323
8324   if ((base == mach_mipsisa32)
8325       && this->mips_mach_extends(mach_mipsisa64, extension))
8326     return true;
8327
8328   if ((base == mach_mipsisa32r2)
8329       && this->mips_mach_extends(mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
8330     return true;
8331
8332   for (unsigned int i = 0; i < this->mips_mach_extensions_.size(); ++i)
8333     if (extension == this->mips_mach_extensions_[i].first)
8334       {
8335         extension = this->mips_mach_extensions_[i].second;
8336         if (extension == base)
8337           return true;
8338       }
8339
8340   return false;
8341 }
8342
8343 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8344 void
8345 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::merge_processor_specific_flags(
8346     const std::string& name, elfcpp::Elf_Word in_flags, bool dyn_obj)
8347 {
8348   // If flags are not set yet, just copy them.
8349   if (!this->are_processor_specific_flags_set())
8350     {
8351       this->set_processor_specific_flags(in_flags);
8352       this->mach_ = this->elf_mips_mach(in_flags);
8353       return;
8354     }
8355
8356   elfcpp::Elf_Word new_flags = in_flags;
8357   elfcpp::Elf_Word old_flags = this->processor_specific_flags();
8358   elfcpp::Elf_Word merged_flags = this->processor_specific_flags();
8359   merged_flags |= new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
8360
8361   // Check flag compatibility.
8362   new_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
8363   old_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
8364
8365   // Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set.  It
8366   // doesn't seem to matter.
8367   new_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_XGOT;
8368   old_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_XGOT;
8369
8370   // MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects.  Again, we should
8371   // just be able to ignore this.
8372   new_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_UCODE;
8373   old_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_UCODE;
8374
8375   // DSOs should only be linked with CPIC code.
8376   if (dyn_obj)
8377     new_flags |= elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC;
8378
8379   if (new_flags == old_flags)
8380     {
8381       this->set_processor_specific_flags(merged_flags);
8382       return;
8383     }
8384
8385   if (((new_flags & (elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
8386       != ((old_flags & (elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
8387     gold_warning(_("%s: linking abicalls files with non-abicalls files"),
8388                  name.c_str());
8389
8390   if (new_flags & (elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC))
8391     merged_flags |= elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC;
8392   if (!(new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC))
8393     merged_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC;
8394
8395   new_flags &= ~(elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC);
8396   old_flags &= ~(elfcpp::EF_MIPS_PIC | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_CPIC);
8397
8398   // Compare the ISAs.
8399   if (mips_32bit_flags(old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags(new_flags))
8400     gold_error(_("%s: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"), name.c_str());
8401   else if (!this->mips_mach_extends(this->elf_mips_mach(in_flags), this->mach_))
8402     {
8403       // Output ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, input ISA.
8404       if (this->mips_mach_extends(this->mach_, this->elf_mips_mach(in_flags)))
8405         {
8406           // Copy the architecture info from input object to output.  Also copy
8407           // the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
8408           // output as a 32-bit binary.
8409           this->mach_ = this->elf_mips_mach(in_flags);
8410           merged_flags &= ~(elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH);
8411           merged_flags |= (new_flags & (elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH
8412                            | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_32BITMODE));
8413
8414           // Copy across the ABI flags if output doesn't use them
8415           // and if that was what caused us to treat input object as 32-bit.
8416           if ((old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
8417               && this->mips_32bit_flags(new_flags)
8418               && !this->mips_32bit_flags(new_flags & ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI))
8419             merged_flags |= new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI;
8420         }
8421       else
8422         // The ISAs aren't compatible.
8423         gold_error(_("%s: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
8424                    name.c_str(), this->elf_mips_mach_name(in_flags),
8425                    this->elf_mips_mach_name(merged_flags));
8426     }
8427
8428   new_flags &= (~(elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH
8429                 | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_32BITMODE));
8430   old_flags &= (~(elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH
8431                 | elfcpp::EF_MIPS_32BITMODE));
8432
8433   // Compare ABIs.
8434   if ((new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI))
8435     {
8436       // Only error if both are set (to different values).
8437       if ((new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI)
8438            && (old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI))
8439         gold_error(_("%s: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with "
8440                      "previous %s modules"), name.c_str(),
8441                    this->elf_mips_abi_name(in_flags),
8442                    this->elf_mips_abi_name(merged_flags));
8443
8444       new_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI;
8445       old_flags &= ~elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI;
8446     }
8447
8448   // Compare ASEs.  Forbid linking MIPS16 and microMIPS ASE modules together
8449   // and allow arbitrary mixing of the remaining ASEs (retain the union).
8450   if ((new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE)
8451       != (old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
8452     {
8453       int old_micro = old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
8454       int new_micro = new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
8455       int old_m16 = old_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
8456       int new_m16 = new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
8457       int micro_mis = old_m16 && new_micro;
8458       int m16_mis = old_micro && new_m16;
8459
8460       if (m16_mis || micro_mis)
8461         gold_error(_("%s: ASE mismatch: linking %s module with "
8462                      "previous %s modules"), name.c_str(),
8463                    m16_mis ? "MIPS16" : "microMIPS",
8464                    m16_mis ? "microMIPS" : "MIPS16");
8465
8466       merged_flags |= new_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
8467
8468       new_flags &= ~ elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
8469       old_flags &= ~ elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
8470     }
8471
8472   // Warn about any other mismatches.
8473   if (new_flags != old_flags)
8474     gold_error(_("%s: uses different e_flags (0x%x) fields than previous "
8475                  "modules (0x%x)"), name.c_str(), new_flags, old_flags);
8476
8477   this->set_processor_specific_flags(merged_flags);
8478 }
8479
8480 // Adjust ELF file header.
8481
8482 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8483 void
8484 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_adjust_elf_header(
8485     unsigned char* view,
8486     int len)
8487 {
8488   gold_assert(len == elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::ehdr_size);
8489
8490   if (!this->entry_symbol_is_compressed_)
8491     return;
8492
8493   elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian> ehdr(view);
8494   elfcpp::Ehdr_write<size, big_endian> oehdr(view);
8495
8496   oehdr.put_e_entry(ehdr.get_e_entry() + 1);
8497 }
8498
8499 // do_make_elf_object to override the same function in the base class.
8500 // We need to use a target-specific sub-class of
8501 // Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian> to store Mips specific information.
8502 // Hence we need to have our own ELF object creation.
8503
8504 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8505 Object*
8506 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_make_elf_object(
8507     const std::string& name,
8508     Input_file* input_file,
8509     off_t offset, const elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian>& ehdr)
8510 {
8511   int et = ehdr.get_e_type();
8512   // ET_EXEC files are valid input for --just-symbols/-R,
8513   // and we treat them as relocatable objects.
8514   if (et == elfcpp::ET_REL
8515       || (et == elfcpp::ET_EXEC && input_file->just_symbols()))
8516     {
8517       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* obj =
8518         new Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>(name, input_file, offset, ehdr);
8519       obj->setup();
8520       return obj;
8521     }
8522   else if (et == elfcpp::ET_DYN)
8523     {
8524       // TODO(sasa): Should we create Mips_dynobj?
8525       return Target::do_make_elf_object(name, input_file, offset, ehdr);
8526     }
8527   else
8528     {
8529       gold_error(_("%s: unsupported ELF file type %d"),
8530                  name.c_str(), et);
8531       return NULL;
8532     }
8533 }
8534
8535 // Finalize the sections.
8536
8537 template <int size, bool big_endian>
8538 void
8539 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_finalize_sections(Layout* layout,
8540                                         const Input_objects* input_objects,
8541                                         Symbol_table* symtab)
8542 {
8543   // Add +1 to MIPS16 and microMIPS init_ and _fini symbols so that DT_INIT and
8544   // DT_FINI have correct values.
8545   Mips_symbol<size>* init = static_cast<Mips_symbol<size>*>(
8546       symtab->lookup(parameters->options().init()));
8547   if (init != NULL && (init->is_mips16() || init->is_micromips()))
8548     init->set_value(init->value() | 1);
8549   Mips_symbol<size>* fini = static_cast<Mips_symbol<size>*>(
8550       symtab->lookup(parameters->options().fini()));
8551   if (fini != NULL && (fini->is_mips16() || fini->is_micromips()))
8552     fini->set_value(fini->value() | 1);
8553
8554   // Check whether the entry symbol is mips16 or micromips.  This is needed to
8555   // adjust entry address in ELF header.
8556   Mips_symbol<size>* entry =
8557     static_cast<Mips_symbol<size>*>(symtab->lookup(this->entry_symbol_name()));
8558   this->entry_symbol_is_compressed_ = (entry != NULL && (entry->is_mips16()
8559                                        || entry->is_micromips()));
8560
8561   if (!parameters->doing_static_link()
8562       && (strcmp(parameters->options().hash_style(), "gnu") == 0
8563           || strcmp(parameters->options().hash_style(), "both") == 0))
8564     {
8565       // .gnu.hash and the MIPS ABI require .dynsym to be sorted in different
8566       // ways.  .gnu.hash needs symbols to be grouped by hash code whereas the
8567       // MIPS ABI requires a mapping between the GOT and the symbol table.
8568       gold_error(".gnu.hash is incompatible with the MIPS ABI");
8569     }
8570
8571   // Check whether the final section that was scanned has HI16 or GOT16
8572   // relocations without the corresponding LO16 part.
8573   if (this->got16_addends_.size() > 0)
8574       gold_error("Can't find matching LO16 reloc");
8575
8576   // Set _gp value.
8577   this->set_gp(layout, symtab);
8578
8579   // Check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard.
8580   if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
8581     {
8582       for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
8583           p != input_objects->relobj_end();
8584           ++p)
8585         {
8586           Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
8587             Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(*p);
8588           object->discard_mips16_stub_sections(symtab);
8589         }
8590     }
8591
8592   // Merge processor-specific flags.
8593   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
8594        p != input_objects->relobj_end();
8595        ++p)
8596     {
8597       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* relobj =
8598         Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(*p);
8599
8600       Input_file::Format format = relobj->input_file()->format();
8601       if (format == Input_file::FORMAT_ELF)
8602         {
8603           // Read processor-specific flags in ELF file header.
8604           const unsigned char* pehdr = relobj->get_view(
8605                                             elfcpp::file_header_offset,
8606                                             elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::ehdr_size,
8607                                             true, false);
8608
8609           elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian> ehdr(pehdr);
8610           elfcpp::Elf_Word in_flags = ehdr.get_e_flags();
8611           // If all input sections will be discarded, don't use this object
8612           // file for merging processor specific flags.
8613           bool should_merge_processor_specific_flags = false;
8614
8615           for (unsigned int i = 1; i < relobj->shnum(); ++i)
8616             if (relobj->output_section(i) != NULL)
8617               {
8618                 should_merge_processor_specific_flags = true;
8619                 break;
8620               }
8621
8622           if (should_merge_processor_specific_flags)
8623             this->merge_processor_specific_flags(relobj->name(), in_flags,
8624                                                  false);
8625         }
8626     }
8627
8628   for (Input_objects::Dynobj_iterator p = input_objects->dynobj_begin();
8629        p != input_objects->dynobj_end();
8630        ++p)
8631     {
8632       Sized_dynobj<size, big_endian>* dynobj =
8633         static_cast<Sized_dynobj<size, big_endian>*>(*p);
8634
8635       // Read processor-specific flags.
8636       const unsigned char* pehdr = dynobj->get_view(elfcpp::file_header_offset,
8637                                            elfcpp::Elf_sizes<size>::ehdr_size,
8638                                            true, false);
8639
8640       elfcpp::Ehdr<size, big_endian> ehdr(pehdr);
8641       elfcpp::Elf_Word in_flags = ehdr.get_e_flags();
8642
8643       this->merge_processor_specific_flags(dynobj->name(), in_flags, true);
8644     }
8645
8646   // Merge .reginfo contents of input objects.
8647   Valtype gprmask = 0;
8648   Valtype cprmask1 = 0;
8649   Valtype cprmask2 = 0;
8650   Valtype cprmask3 = 0;
8651   Valtype cprmask4 = 0;
8652   for (Input_objects::Relobj_iterator p = input_objects->relobj_begin();
8653        p != input_objects->relobj_end();
8654        ++p)
8655     {
8656       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* relobj =
8657         Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(*p);
8658
8659       gprmask |= relobj->gprmask();
8660       cprmask1 |= relobj->cprmask1();
8661       cprmask2 |= relobj->cprmask2();
8662       cprmask3 |= relobj->cprmask3();
8663       cprmask4 |= relobj->cprmask4();
8664     }
8665
8666   if (this->plt_ != NULL)
8667     {
8668       // Set final PLT offsets for symbols.
8669       this->plt_section()->set_plt_offsets();
8670
8671       // Define _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_ at the start of the .plt section.
8672       // Set STO_MICROMIPS flag if the output has microMIPS code, but only if
8673       // there are no standard PLT entries present.
8674       unsigned char nonvis = 0;
8675       if (this->is_output_micromips()
8676           && !this->plt_section()->has_standard_entries())
8677         nonvis = elfcpp::STO_MICROMIPS >> 2;
8678       symtab->define_in_output_data("_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_", NULL,
8679                                     Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8680                                     this->plt_,
8681                                     0, 0, elfcpp::STT_FUNC,
8682                                     elfcpp::STB_LOCAL,
8683                                     elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT, nonvis,
8684                                     false, false);
8685     }
8686
8687   if (this->mips_stubs_ != NULL)
8688     {
8689       // Define _MIPS_STUBS_ at the start of the .MIPS.stubs section.
8690       unsigned char nonvis = 0;
8691       if (this->is_output_micromips())
8692         nonvis = elfcpp::STO_MICROMIPS >> 2;
8693       symtab->define_in_output_data("_MIPS_STUBS_", NULL,
8694                                     Symbol_table::PREDEFINED,
8695                                     this->mips_stubs_,
8696                                     0, 0, elfcpp::STT_FUNC,
8697                                     elfcpp::STB_LOCAL,
8698                                     elfcpp::STV_DEFAULT, nonvis,
8699                                     false, false);
8700     }
8701
8702   if (!parameters->options().relocatable() && !parameters->doing_static_link())
8703     // In case there is no .got section, create one.
8704     this->got_section(symtab, layout);
8705
8706   // Emit any relocs we saved in an attempt to avoid generating COPY
8707   // relocs.
8708   if (this->copy_relocs_.any_saved_relocs())
8709     this->copy_relocs_.emit_mips(this->rel_dyn_section(layout), symtab, layout,
8710                                  this);
8711
8712   // Emit dynamic relocs.
8713   for (typename std::vector<Dyn_reloc>::iterator p = this->dyn_relocs_.begin();
8714        p != this->dyn_relocs_.end();
8715        ++p)
8716     p->emit(this->rel_dyn_section(layout), this->got_section(), symtab);
8717
8718   if (this->has_got_section())
8719     this->got_section()->lay_out_got(layout, symtab, input_objects);
8720
8721   if (this->mips_stubs_ != NULL)
8722     this->mips_stubs_->set_needs_dynsym_value();
8723
8724   // Check for functions that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
8725   // TODO(sasa): Can we do this without iterating over all symbols?
8726   typedef Symbol_visitor_check_symbols<size, big_endian> Symbol_visitor;
8727   symtab->for_all_symbols<size, Symbol_visitor>(Symbol_visitor(this, layout,
8728                                                                symtab));
8729
8730   // Add NULL segment.
8731   if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
8732     layout->make_output_segment(elfcpp::PT_NULL, 0);
8733
8734   for (Layout::Section_list::const_iterator p = layout->section_list().begin();
8735        p != layout->section_list().end();
8736        ++p)
8737     {
8738       if ((*p)->type() == elfcpp::SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
8739         {
8740           Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>* reginfo =
8741             Mips_output_section_reginfo<size, big_endian>::
8742               as_mips_output_section_reginfo(*p);
8743
8744           reginfo->set_masks(gprmask, cprmask1, cprmask2, cprmask3, cprmask4);
8745
8746           if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
8747             {
8748               Output_segment* reginfo_segment =
8749                 layout->make_output_segment(elfcpp::PT_MIPS_REGINFO,
8750                                             elfcpp::PF_R);
8751               reginfo_segment->add_output_section_to_nonload(reginfo,
8752                                                              elfcpp::PF_R);
8753             }
8754         }
8755     }
8756
8757   // Fill in some more dynamic tags.
8758   // TODO(sasa): Add more dynamic tags.
8759   const Reloc_section* rel_plt = (this->plt_ == NULL
8760                                   ? NULL : this->plt_->rel_plt());
8761   layout->add_target_dynamic_tags(true, this->got_, rel_plt,
8762                                   this->rel_dyn_, true, false);
8763
8764   Output_data_dynamic* const odyn = layout->dynamic_data();
8765   if (odyn != NULL
8766       && !parameters->options().relocatable()
8767       && !parameters->doing_static_link())
8768   {
8769     unsigned int d_val;
8770     // This element holds a 32-bit version id for the Runtime
8771     // Linker Interface.  This will start at integer value 1.
8772     d_val = 0x01;
8773     odyn->add_constant(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, d_val);
8774
8775     // Dynamic flags
8776     d_val = elfcpp::RHF_NOTPOT;
8777     odyn->add_constant(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_FLAGS, d_val);
8778
8779     // Save layout for using when emiting custom dynamic tags.
8780     this->layout_ = layout;
8781
8782     // This member holds the base address of the segment.
8783     odyn->add_custom(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS);
8784
8785     // This member holds the number of entries in the .dynsym section.
8786     odyn->add_custom(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO);
8787
8788     // This member holds the index of the first dynamic symbol
8789     // table entry that corresponds to an entry in the global offset table.
8790     odyn->add_custom(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_GOTSYM);
8791
8792     // This member holds the number of local GOT entries.
8793     odyn->add_constant(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO,
8794                        this->got_->get_local_gotno());
8795
8796     if (this->plt_ != NULL)
8797       // DT_MIPS_PLTGOT dynamic tag
8798       odyn->add_section_address(elfcpp::DT_MIPS_PLTGOT, this->got_plt_);
8799   }
8800  }
8801
8802 // Get the custom dynamic tag value.
8803 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8804 unsigned int
8805 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::do_dynamic_tag_custom_value(elfcpp::DT tag) const
8806 {
8807   switch (tag)
8808     {
8809     case elfcpp::DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
8810       {
8811         // The base address of the segment.
8812         // At this point, the segment list has been sorted into final order,
8813         // so just return vaddr of the first readable PT_LOAD segment.
8814         Output_segment* seg =
8815           this->layout_->find_output_segment(elfcpp::PT_LOAD, elfcpp::PF_R, 0);
8816         gold_assert(seg != NULL);
8817         return seg->vaddr();
8818       }
8819
8820     case elfcpp::DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
8821       // The number of entries in the .dynsym section.
8822       return this->get_dt_mips_symtabno();
8823
8824     case elfcpp::DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
8825       {
8826         // The index of the first dynamic symbol table entry that corresponds
8827         // to an entry in the GOT.
8828         if (this->got_->first_global_got_dynsym_index() != -1U)
8829           return this->got_->first_global_got_dynsym_index();
8830         else
8831           // In case if we don't have global GOT symbols we default to setting
8832           // DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO.
8833           return this->get_dt_mips_symtabno();
8834       }
8835
8836     default:
8837       gold_error(_("Unknown dynamic tag 0x%x"), (unsigned int)tag);
8838     }
8839
8840   return (unsigned int)-1;
8841 }
8842
8843 // Relocate section data.
8844
8845 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8846 void
8847 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::relocate_section(
8848                         const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>* relinfo,
8849                         unsigned int sh_type,
8850                         const unsigned char* prelocs,
8851                         size_t reloc_count,
8852                         Output_section* output_section,
8853                         bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8854                         unsigned char* view,
8855                         Mips_address address,
8856                         section_size_type view_size,
8857                         const Reloc_symbol_changes* reloc_symbol_changes)
8858 {
8859   typedef Target_mips<size, big_endian> Mips;
8860   typedef typename Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Relocate Mips_relocate;
8861
8862   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
8863     {
8864       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
8865           Classify_reloc;
8866
8867       gold::relocate_section<size, big_endian, Mips, Mips_relocate,
8868                              gold::Default_comdat_behavior, Classify_reloc>(
8869         relinfo,
8870         this,
8871         prelocs,
8872         reloc_count,
8873         output_section,
8874         needs_special_offset_handling,
8875         view,
8876         address,
8877         view_size,
8878         reloc_symbol_changes);
8879     }
8880   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
8881     {
8882       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
8883           Classify_reloc;
8884
8885       gold::relocate_section<size, big_endian, Mips, Mips_relocate,
8886                              gold::Default_comdat_behavior, Classify_reloc>(
8887         relinfo,
8888         this,
8889         prelocs,
8890         reloc_count,
8891         output_section,
8892         needs_special_offset_handling,
8893         view,
8894         address,
8895         view_size,
8896         reloc_symbol_changes);
8897     }
8898 }
8899
8900 // Return the size of a relocation while scanning during a relocatable
8901 // link.
8902
8903 unsigned int
8904 mips_get_size_for_reloc(unsigned int r_type, Relobj* object)
8905 {
8906   switch (r_type)
8907     {
8908     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE:
8909     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64:
8910     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
8911     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
8912       return 0;
8913
8914     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_32:
8915     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32:
8916     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
8917     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
8918     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32:
8919     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC32:
8920     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL32:
8921     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR:
8922     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
8923       return 4;
8924
8925     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_16:
8926     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
8927     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16:
8928     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL16:
8929     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
8930     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16:
8931     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC16:
8932     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
8933     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8934     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
8935     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8936     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8937     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8938     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8939     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8940     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
8941     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
8942     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
8943     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
8944     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GPREL:
8945     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8946     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LITERAL:
8947     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8948     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
8949     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8950     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8951     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8952       return 2;
8953
8954     // These relocations are not byte sized
8955     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
8956     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
8957       return 4;
8958
8959     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_COPY:
8960     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT:
8961       object->error(_("unexpected reloc %u in object file"), r_type);
8962       return 0;
8963
8964     default:
8965       object->error(_("unsupported reloc %u in object file"), r_type);
8966       return 0;
8967   }
8968 }
8969
8970 // Scan the relocs during a relocatable link.
8971
8972 template<int size, bool big_endian>
8973 void
8974 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::scan_relocatable_relocs(
8975                         Symbol_table* symtab,
8976                         Layout* layout,
8977                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
8978                         unsigned int data_shndx,
8979                         unsigned int sh_type,
8980                         const unsigned char* prelocs,
8981                         size_t reloc_count,
8982                         Output_section* output_section,
8983                         bool needs_special_offset_handling,
8984                         size_t local_symbol_count,
8985                         const unsigned char* plocal_symbols,
8986                         Relocatable_relocs* rr)
8987 {
8988   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
8989     {
8990       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
8991           Classify_reloc;
8992       typedef Mips_scan_relocatable_relocs<big_endian, Classify_reloc>
8993           Scan_relocatable_relocs;
8994
8995       gold::scan_relocatable_relocs<size, big_endian, Scan_relocatable_relocs>(
8996         symtab,
8997         layout,
8998         object,
8999         data_shndx,
9000         prelocs,
9001         reloc_count,
9002         output_section,
9003         needs_special_offset_handling,
9004         local_symbol_count,
9005         plocal_symbols,
9006         rr);
9007     }
9008   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
9009     {
9010       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
9011           Classify_reloc;
9012       typedef Mips_scan_relocatable_relocs<big_endian, Classify_reloc>
9013           Scan_relocatable_relocs;
9014
9015       gold::scan_relocatable_relocs<size, big_endian, Scan_relocatable_relocs>(
9016         symtab,
9017         layout,
9018         object,
9019         data_shndx,
9020         prelocs,
9021         reloc_count,
9022         output_section,
9023         needs_special_offset_handling,
9024         local_symbol_count,
9025         plocal_symbols,
9026         rr);
9027     }
9028   else
9029     gold_unreachable();
9030 }
9031
9032 // Scan the relocs for --emit-relocs.
9033
9034 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9035 void
9036 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::emit_relocs_scan(
9037     Symbol_table* symtab,
9038     Layout* layout,
9039     Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
9040     unsigned int data_shndx,
9041     unsigned int sh_type,
9042     const unsigned char* prelocs,
9043     size_t reloc_count,
9044     Output_section* output_section,
9045     bool needs_special_offset_handling,
9046     size_t local_symbol_count,
9047     const unsigned char* plocal_syms,
9048     Relocatable_relocs* rr)
9049 {
9050   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
9051     {
9052       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
9053           Classify_reloc;
9054       typedef gold::Default_emit_relocs_strategy<Classify_reloc>
9055           Emit_relocs_strategy;
9056
9057       gold::scan_relocatable_relocs<size, big_endian, Emit_relocs_strategy>(
9058         symtab,
9059         layout,
9060         object,
9061         data_shndx,
9062         prelocs,
9063         reloc_count,
9064         output_section,
9065         needs_special_offset_handling,
9066         local_symbol_count,
9067         plocal_syms,
9068         rr);
9069     }
9070   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
9071     {
9072       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
9073           Classify_reloc;
9074       typedef gold::Default_emit_relocs_strategy<Classify_reloc>
9075           Emit_relocs_strategy;
9076
9077       gold::scan_relocatable_relocs<size, big_endian, Emit_relocs_strategy>(
9078         symtab,
9079         layout,
9080         object,
9081         data_shndx,
9082         prelocs,
9083         reloc_count,
9084         output_section,
9085         needs_special_offset_handling,
9086         local_symbol_count,
9087         plocal_syms,
9088         rr);
9089     }
9090   else
9091     gold_unreachable();
9092 }
9093
9094 // Emit relocations for a section.
9095
9096 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9097 void
9098 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::relocate_relocs(
9099                         const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>* relinfo,
9100                         unsigned int sh_type,
9101                         const unsigned char* prelocs,
9102                         size_t reloc_count,
9103                         Output_section* output_section,
9104                         typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Off
9105                           offset_in_output_section,
9106                         unsigned char* view,
9107                         Mips_address view_address,
9108                         section_size_type view_size,
9109                         unsigned char* reloc_view,
9110                         section_size_type reloc_view_size)
9111 {
9112   if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
9113     {
9114       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>
9115           Classify_reloc;
9116
9117       gold::relocate_relocs<size, big_endian, Classify_reloc>(
9118         relinfo,
9119         prelocs,
9120         reloc_count,
9121         output_section,
9122         offset_in_output_section,
9123         view,
9124         view_address,
9125         view_size,
9126         reloc_view,
9127         reloc_view_size);
9128     }
9129   else if (sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
9130     {
9131       typedef Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>
9132           Classify_reloc;
9133
9134       gold::relocate_relocs<size, big_endian, Classify_reloc>(
9135         relinfo,
9136         prelocs,
9137         reloc_count,
9138         output_section,
9139         offset_in_output_section,
9140         view,
9141         view_address,
9142         view_size,
9143         reloc_view,
9144         reloc_view_size);
9145     }
9146   else
9147     gold_unreachable();
9148 }
9149
9150 // Perform target-specific processing in a relocatable link.  This is
9151 // only used if we use the relocation strategy RELOC_SPECIAL.
9152
9153 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9154 void
9155 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::relocate_special_relocatable(
9156     const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>* relinfo,
9157     unsigned int sh_type,
9158     const unsigned char* preloc_in,
9159     size_t relnum,
9160     Output_section* output_section,
9161     typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Off offset_in_output_section,
9162     unsigned char* view,
9163     Mips_address view_address,
9164     section_size_type,
9165     unsigned char* preloc_out)
9166 {
9167   // We can only handle REL type relocation sections.
9168   gold_assert(sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL);
9169
9170   typedef typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::Reloc
9171     Reltype;
9172   typedef typename Reloc_types<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::Reloc_write
9173     Reltype_write;
9174
9175   typedef Mips_relocate_functions<size, big_endian> Reloc_funcs;
9176
9177   const Mips_address invalid_address = static_cast<Mips_address>(0) - 1;
9178
9179   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
9180     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(relinfo->object);
9181   const unsigned int local_count = object->local_symbol_count();
9182
9183   Reltype reloc(preloc_in);
9184   Reltype_write reloc_write(preloc_out);
9185
9186   elfcpp::Elf_types<32>::Elf_WXword r_info = reloc.get_r_info();
9187   const unsigned int r_sym = elfcpp::elf_r_sym<size>(r_info);
9188   const unsigned int r_type = elfcpp::elf_r_type<size>(r_info);
9189
9190   // Get the new symbol index.
9191   // We only use RELOC_SPECIAL strategy in local relocations.
9192   gold_assert(r_sym < local_count);
9193
9194   // We are adjusting a section symbol.  We need to find
9195   // the symbol table index of the section symbol for
9196   // the output section corresponding to input section
9197   // in which this symbol is defined.
9198   bool is_ordinary;
9199   unsigned int shndx = object->local_symbol_input_shndx(r_sym, &is_ordinary);
9200   gold_assert(is_ordinary);
9201   Output_section* os = object->output_section(shndx);
9202   gold_assert(os != NULL);
9203   gold_assert(os->needs_symtab_index());
9204   unsigned int new_symndx = os->symtab_index();
9205
9206   // Get the new offset--the location in the output section where
9207   // this relocation should be applied.
9208
9209   Mips_address offset = reloc.get_r_offset();
9210   Mips_address new_offset;
9211   if (offset_in_output_section != invalid_address)
9212     new_offset = offset + offset_in_output_section;
9213   else
9214     {
9215       section_offset_type sot_offset =
9216         convert_types<section_offset_type, Mips_address>(offset);
9217       section_offset_type new_sot_offset =
9218         output_section->output_offset(object, relinfo->data_shndx,
9219                                       sot_offset);
9220       gold_assert(new_sot_offset != -1);
9221       new_offset = new_sot_offset;
9222     }
9223
9224   // In an object file, r_offset is an offset within the section.
9225   // In an executable or dynamic object, generated by
9226   // --emit-relocs, r_offset is an absolute address.
9227   if (!parameters->options().relocatable())
9228     {
9229       new_offset += view_address;
9230       if (offset_in_output_section != invalid_address)
9231         new_offset -= offset_in_output_section;
9232     }
9233
9234   reloc_write.put_r_offset(new_offset);
9235   reloc_write.put_r_info(elfcpp::elf_r_info<32>(new_symndx, r_type));
9236
9237   // Handle the reloc addend.
9238   // The relocation uses a section symbol in the input file.
9239   // We are adjusting it to use a section symbol in the output
9240   // file.  The input section symbol refers to some address in
9241   // the input section.  We need the relocation in the output
9242   // file to refer to that same address.  This adjustment to
9243   // the addend is the same calculation we use for a simple
9244   // absolute relocation for the input section symbol.
9245   Valtype calculated_value = 0;
9246   const Symbol_value<size>* psymval = object->local_symbol(r_sym);
9247
9248   unsigned char* paddend = view + offset;
9249   typename Reloc_funcs::Status reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OKAY;
9250   switch (r_type)
9251     {
9252     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
9253       reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel26(paddend, object, psymval,
9254           offset_in_output_section, true, 0, sh_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL, NULL,
9255           false /*TODO(sasa): cross mode jump*/, r_type, this->jal_to_bal(),
9256           false, &calculated_value);
9257       break;
9258
9259     default:
9260       gold_unreachable();
9261     }
9262
9263   // Report any errors.
9264   switch (reloc_status)
9265     {
9266     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OKAY:
9267       break;
9268     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OVERFLOW:
9269       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, reloc.get_r_offset(),
9270                              _("relocation overflow"));
9271       break;
9272     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_BAD_RELOC:
9273       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, reloc.get_r_offset(),
9274         _("unexpected opcode while processing relocation"));
9275       break;
9276     default:
9277       gold_unreachable();
9278     }
9279 }
9280
9281 // Optimize the TLS relocation type based on what we know about the
9282 // symbol.  IS_FINAL is true if the final address of this symbol is
9283 // known at link time.
9284
9285 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9286 tls::Tls_optimization
9287 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(bool, int)
9288 {
9289   // FIXME: Currently we do not do any TLS optimization.
9290   return tls::TLSOPT_NONE;
9291 }
9292
9293 // Scan a relocation for a local symbol.
9294
9295 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9296 inline void
9297 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::local(
9298                         Symbol_table* symtab,
9299                         Layout* layout,
9300                         Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
9301                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
9302                         unsigned int data_shndx,
9303                         Output_section* output_section,
9304                         const Relatype* rela,
9305                         const Reltype* rel,
9306                         unsigned int rel_type,
9307                         unsigned int r_type,
9308                         const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
9309                         bool is_discarded)
9310 {
9311   if (is_discarded)
9312     return;
9313
9314   Mips_address r_offset;
9315   unsigned int r_sym;
9316   typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Swxword r_addend;
9317
9318   if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
9319     {
9320       r_offset = rela->get_r_offset();
9321       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
9322           get_r_sym(rela);
9323       r_addend = rela->get_r_addend();
9324     }
9325   else
9326     {
9327       r_offset = rel->get_r_offset();
9328       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::
9329           get_r_sym(rel);
9330       r_addend = 0;
9331     }
9332
9333   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* mips_obj =
9334     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(object);
9335
9336   if (mips_obj->is_mips16_stub_section(data_shndx))
9337     {
9338       mips_obj->get_mips16_stub_section(data_shndx)
9339               ->new_local_reloc_found(r_type, r_sym);
9340     }
9341
9342   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE)
9343     // R_MIPS_NONE is used in mips16 stub sections, to define the target of the
9344     // mips16 stub.
9345     return;
9346
9347   if (!mips16_call_reloc(r_type)
9348       && !mips_obj->section_allows_mips16_refs(data_shndx))
9349     // This reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub, if
9350     // there is one.  We ignore MIPS16 stub sections and .pdr section when
9351     // looking for relocs that would need to refer to MIPS16 stubs.
9352     mips_obj->add_local_non_16bit_call(r_sym);
9353
9354   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26
9355       && !mips_obj->section_allows_mips16_refs(data_shndx))
9356     mips_obj->add_local_16bit_call(r_sym);
9357
9358   switch (r_type)
9359     {
9360     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
9361     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
9362     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9363     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9364     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9365     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9366     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9367     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9368     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9369     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9370     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
9371     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
9372     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
9373     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
9374     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9375     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
9376     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
9377     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
9378     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
9379     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
9380     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
9381     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
9382     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
9383     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9384     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
9385     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
9386     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9387     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
9388     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
9389     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
9390       // We need a GOT section.
9391       target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9392       break;
9393
9394     default:
9395       break;
9396     }
9397
9398   if (call_lo16_reloc(r_type)
9399       || got_lo16_reloc(r_type)
9400       || got_disp_reloc(r_type)
9401       || eh_reloc(r_type))
9402     {
9403       // We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation.  We
9404       // don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
9405       // maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
9406       // the segment.  Similar comments apply to R_MIPS*_GOT16 and
9407       // R_MIPS*_CALL16.  We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
9408       // R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
9409       // R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16.
9410       Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
9411         target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9412       bool is_section_symbol = lsym.get_st_type() == elfcpp::STT_SECTION;
9413       got->record_local_got_symbol(mips_obj, r_sym, r_addend, r_type, -1U,
9414                                    is_section_symbol);
9415     }
9416
9417   switch (r_type)
9418     {
9419     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
9420     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
9421     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
9422       gold_error(_("CALL16 reloc at 0x%lx not against global symbol "),
9423                  (unsigned long)r_offset);
9424       return;
9425
9426     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9427     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9428     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
9429     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
9430     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9431     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9432     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
9433     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
9434     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
9435       {
9436         // This relocation needs a page entry in the GOT.
9437         // Get the section contents.
9438         section_size_type view_size = 0;
9439         const unsigned char* view = object->section_contents(data_shndx,
9440                                                              &view_size, false);
9441         view += r_offset;
9442
9443         Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
9444         Valtype32 addend = (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL ? val & 0xffff
9445                                                         : r_addend);
9446
9447         if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL && got16_reloc(r_type))
9448           target->got16_addends_.push_back(got16_addend<size, big_endian>(
9449               object, data_shndx, r_type, r_sym, addend));
9450         else
9451           target->got_section()->record_got_page_entry(mips_obj, r_sym, addend);
9452         break;
9453       }
9454
9455     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
9456     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
9457     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
9458       // Record the reloc so that we can check whether the corresponding LO16
9459       // part exists.
9460       if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
9461         target->got16_addends_.push_back(got16_addend<size, big_endian>(
9462             object, data_shndx, r_type, r_sym, 0));
9463       break;
9464
9465     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16:
9466     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16:
9467     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
9468       {
9469         if (rel_type != elfcpp::SHT_REL)
9470           break;
9471
9472         // Find corresponding GOT16/HI16 relocation.
9473
9474         // According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
9475         // be immediately following.  However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
9476         // relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
9477         // relocations for the same address.  In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
9478         // relocation may occur as one of these.  We permit a similar
9479         // extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
9480
9481         // In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but
9482         // keeps the corresponding HI16.  This is strictly speaking a
9483         // violation of the ABI but not immediately harmful.
9484
9485         typename std::list<got16_addend<size, big_endian> >::iterator it =
9486           target->got16_addends_.begin();
9487         while (it != target->got16_addends_.end())
9488           {
9489             got16_addend<size, big_endian> _got16_addend = *it;
9490
9491             // TODO(sasa): Split got16_addends_ list into two lists - one for
9492             // GOT16 relocs and the other for HI16 relocs.
9493
9494             // Report an error if we find HI16 or GOT16 reloc from the
9495             // previous section without the matching LO16 part.
9496             if (_got16_addend.object != object
9497                 || _got16_addend.shndx != data_shndx)
9498               {
9499                 gold_error("Can't find matching LO16 reloc");
9500                 break;
9501               }
9502
9503             if (_got16_addend.r_sym != r_sym
9504                 || !is_matching_lo16_reloc(_got16_addend.r_type, r_type))
9505               {
9506                 ++it;
9507                 continue;
9508               }
9509
9510             // We found a matching HI16 or GOT16 reloc for this LO16 reloc.
9511             // For GOT16, we need to calculate combined addend and record GOT page
9512             // entry.
9513             if (got16_reloc(_got16_addend.r_type))
9514               {
9515
9516                 section_size_type view_size = 0;
9517                 const unsigned char* view = object->section_contents(data_shndx,
9518                                                                      &view_size,
9519                                                                      false);
9520                 view += r_offset;
9521
9522                 Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
9523                 int32_t addend = Bits<16>::sign_extend32(val & 0xffff);
9524
9525                 addend = (_got16_addend.addend << 16) + addend;
9526                 target->got_section()->record_got_page_entry(mips_obj, r_sym,
9527                                                              addend);
9528               }
9529
9530             it = target->got16_addends_.erase(it);
9531           }
9532         break;
9533       }
9534     }
9535
9536   switch (r_type)
9537     {
9538     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_32:
9539     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32:
9540     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_64:
9541       {
9542         if (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent())
9543           {
9544             // If building a shared library (or a position-independent
9545             // executable), we need to create a dynamic relocation for
9546             // this location.
9547             if (is_readonly_section(output_section))
9548               break;
9549             Reloc_section* rel_dyn = target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
9550             rel_dyn->add_symbolless_local_addend(object, r_sym,
9551                                                  elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32,
9552                                                  output_section, data_shndx,
9553                                                  r_offset);
9554           }
9555         break;
9556       }
9557
9558     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9559     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9560     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9561     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
9562     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
9563     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
9564     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
9565     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
9566     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
9567       {
9568         bool output_is_shared = parameters->options().shared();
9569         const tls::Tls_optimization optimized_type
9570             = Target_mips<size, big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(
9571                                              !output_is_shared, r_type);
9572         switch (r_type)
9573           {
9574           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
9575           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
9576           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
9577             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9578               {
9579                 // Create a pair of GOT entries for the module index and
9580                 // dtv-relative offset.
9581                 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
9582                   target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9583                 unsigned int shndx = lsym.get_st_shndx();
9584                 bool is_ordinary;
9585                 shndx = object->adjust_sym_shndx(r_sym, shndx, &is_ordinary);
9586                 if (!is_ordinary)
9587                   {
9588                     object->error(_("local symbol %u has bad shndx %u"),
9589                                   r_sym, shndx);
9590                     break;
9591                   }
9592                 got->record_local_got_symbol(mips_obj, r_sym, r_addend, r_type,
9593                                              shndx, false);
9594               }
9595             else
9596               {
9597                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
9598                 gold_unreachable();
9599               }
9600             break;
9601
9602           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
9603           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
9604           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
9605             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9606               {
9607                 // We always record LDM symbols as local with index 0.
9608                 target->got_section()->record_local_got_symbol(mips_obj, 0,
9609                                                                r_addend, r_type,
9610                                                                -1U, false);
9611               }
9612             else
9613               {
9614                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
9615                 gold_unreachable();
9616               }
9617             break;
9618           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9619           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9620           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9621             layout->set_has_static_tls();
9622             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
9623               {
9624                 // Create a GOT entry for the tp-relative offset.
9625                 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
9626                   target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9627                 got->record_local_got_symbol(mips_obj, r_sym, r_addend, r_type,
9628                                              -1U, false);
9629               }
9630             else
9631               {
9632                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
9633                 gold_unreachable();
9634               }
9635             break;
9636
9637           default:
9638             gold_unreachable();
9639         }
9640       }
9641       break;
9642
9643     default:
9644       break;
9645     }
9646
9647   // Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
9648   // shared library.  Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
9649   // not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
9650   // will be fine.  Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
9651   // combined with R_MIPS_GOT16.
9652   if (parameters->options().shared())
9653     {
9654       switch (r_type)
9655         {
9656         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
9657         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
9658         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
9659           // Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
9660           // no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation).
9661           if (r_sym == 0)
9662             break;
9663
9664           // FALLTHROUGH
9665
9666         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
9667         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
9668         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
9669           gold_error(_("%s: relocation %u against `%s' can not be used when "
9670                        "making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
9671                      object->name().c_str(), r_type, "a local symbol");
9672         default:
9673           break;
9674         }
9675     }
9676 }
9677
9678 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9679 inline void
9680 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::local(
9681                         Symbol_table* symtab,
9682                         Layout* layout,
9683                         Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
9684                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
9685                         unsigned int data_shndx,
9686                         Output_section* output_section,
9687                         const Reltype& reloc,
9688                         unsigned int r_type,
9689                         const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
9690                         bool is_discarded)
9691 {
9692   if (is_discarded)
9693     return;
9694
9695   local(
9696     symtab,
9697     layout,
9698     target,
9699     object,
9700     data_shndx,
9701     output_section,
9702     (const Relatype*) NULL,
9703     &reloc,
9704     elfcpp::SHT_REL,
9705     r_type,
9706     lsym, is_discarded);
9707 }
9708
9709
9710 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9711 inline void
9712 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::local(
9713                         Symbol_table* symtab,
9714                         Layout* layout,
9715                         Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
9716                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
9717                         unsigned int data_shndx,
9718                         Output_section* output_section,
9719                         const Relatype& reloc,
9720                         unsigned int r_type,
9721                         const elfcpp::Sym<size, big_endian>& lsym,
9722                         bool is_discarded)
9723 {
9724   if (is_discarded)
9725     return;
9726
9727   local(
9728     symtab,
9729     layout,
9730     target,
9731     object,
9732     data_shndx,
9733     output_section,
9734     &reloc,
9735     (const Reltype*) NULL,
9736     elfcpp::SHT_RELA,
9737     r_type,
9738     lsym, is_discarded);
9739 }
9740
9741 // Scan a relocation for a global symbol.
9742
9743 template<int size, bool big_endian>
9744 inline void
9745 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::global(
9746                                 Symbol_table* symtab,
9747                                 Layout* layout,
9748                                 Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
9749                                 Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
9750                                 unsigned int data_shndx,
9751                                 Output_section* output_section,
9752                                 const Relatype* rela,
9753                                 const Reltype* rel,
9754                                 unsigned int rel_type,
9755                                 unsigned int r_type,
9756                                 Symbol* gsym)
9757 {
9758   Mips_address r_offset;
9759   unsigned int r_sym;
9760   typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Swxword r_addend;
9761
9762   if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
9763     {
9764       r_offset = rela->get_r_offset();
9765       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
9766           get_r_sym(rela);
9767       r_addend = rela->get_r_addend();
9768     }
9769   else
9770     {
9771       r_offset = rel->get_r_offset();
9772       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::
9773           get_r_sym(rel);
9774       r_addend = 0;
9775     }
9776
9777   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* mips_obj =
9778     Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(object);
9779   Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(gsym);
9780
9781   if (mips_obj->is_mips16_stub_section(data_shndx))
9782     {
9783       mips_obj->get_mips16_stub_section(data_shndx)
9784               ->new_global_reloc_found(r_type, mips_sym);
9785     }
9786
9787   if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE)
9788     // R_MIPS_NONE is used in mips16 stub sections, to define the target of the
9789     // mips16 stub.
9790     return;
9791
9792   if (!mips16_call_reloc(r_type)
9793       && !mips_obj->section_allows_mips16_refs(data_shndx))
9794     // This reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub, if
9795     // there is one.  We ignore MIPS16 stub sections and .pdr section when
9796     // looking for relocs that would need to refer to MIPS16 stubs.
9797     mips_sym->set_need_fn_stub();
9798
9799   // A reference to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ implies that we need a got
9800   // section.  We check here to avoid creating a dynamic reloc against
9801   // _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_.
9802   if (!target->has_got_section()
9803       && strcmp(gsym->name(), "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
9804     target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9805
9806   // We need PLT entries if there are static-only relocations against
9807   // an externally-defined function.  This can technically occur for
9808   // shared libraries if there are branches to the symbol, although it
9809   // is unlikely that this will be used in practice due to the short
9810   // ranges involved.  It can occur for any relative or absolute relocation
9811   // in executables; in that case, the PLT entry becomes the function's
9812   // canonical address.
9813   bool static_reloc = false;
9814
9815   // Set CAN_MAKE_DYNAMIC to true if we can convert this
9816   // relocation into a dynamic one.
9817   bool can_make_dynamic = false;
9818   switch (r_type)
9819     {
9820     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
9821     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
9822     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9823     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9824     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
9825     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
9826     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9827     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
9828     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
9829     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9830     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
9831     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
9832     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
9833     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
9834     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9835     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
9836     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
9837     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
9838     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
9839     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
9840     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
9841     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
9842     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
9843     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
9844     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
9845     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
9846     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
9847     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
9848     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
9849     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
9850       // We need a GOT section.
9851       target->got_section(symtab, layout);
9852       break;
9853
9854     // This is just a hint; it can safely be ignored.  Don't set
9855     // has_static_relocs for the corresponding symbol.
9856     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR:
9857     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
9858       break;
9859
9860     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL16:
9861     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL32:
9862     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GPREL:
9863     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
9864       // TODO(sasa)
9865       // GP-relative relocations always resolve to a definition in a
9866       // regular input file, ignoring the one-definition rule.  This is
9867       // important for the GP setup sequence in NewABI code, which
9868       // always resolves to a local function even if other relocations
9869       // against the symbol wouldn't.
9870       //constrain_symbol_p = FALSE;
9871       break;
9872
9873     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_32:
9874     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32:
9875     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_64:
9876       if ((parameters->options().shared()
9877           || (strcmp(gsym->name(), "__gnu_local_gp") != 0
9878           && (!is_readonly_section(output_section)
9879           || mips_obj->is_pic())))
9880           && (output_section->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) != 0)
9881         {
9882           if (r_type != elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32)
9883             mips_sym->set_pointer_equality_needed();
9884           can_make_dynamic = true;
9885           break;
9886         }
9887       // Fall through.
9888
9889     default:
9890       // Most static relocations require pointer equality, except
9891       // for branches.
9892       mips_sym->set_pointer_equality_needed();
9893
9894       // Fall through.
9895
9896     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
9897     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC16:
9898     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
9899     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
9900     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
9901     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
9902     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
9903     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
9904       static_reloc = true;
9905       mips_sym->set_has_static_relocs();
9906       break;
9907     }
9908
9909   // If there are call relocations against an externally-defined symbol,
9910   // see whether we can create a MIPS lazy-binding stub for it.  We can
9911   // only do this if all references to the function are through call
9912   // relocations, and in that case, the traditional lazy-binding stubs
9913   // are much more efficient than PLT entries.
9914   switch (r_type)
9915     {
9916     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
9917     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
9918     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
9919     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
9920     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR:
9921     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
9922     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
9923     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
9924     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
9925       if (!mips_sym->no_lazy_stub())
9926         {
9927           if ((mips_sym->needs_plt_entry() && mips_sym->is_from_dynobj())
9928               // Calls from shared objects to undefined symbols of type
9929               // STT_NOTYPE need lazy-binding stub.
9930               || (mips_sym->is_undefined() && parameters->options().shared()))
9931             target->mips_stubs_section(layout)->make_entry(mips_sym);
9932         }
9933       break;
9934     default:
9935       {
9936         // We must not create a stub for a symbol that has relocations
9937         // related to taking the function's address.
9938         mips_sym->set_no_lazy_stub();
9939         target->remove_lazy_stub_entry(mips_sym);
9940         break;
9941       }
9942   }
9943
9944   if (relocation_needs_la25_stub<size, big_endian>(mips_obj, r_type,
9945                                                    mips_sym->is_mips16()))
9946     mips_sym->set_has_nonpic_branches();
9947
9948   // R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
9949   // and has a special meaning.
9950   bool gp_disp_against_hi16 = (!mips_obj->is_newabi()
9951                                && strcmp(gsym->name(), "_gp_disp") == 0
9952                                && (hi16_reloc(r_type) || lo16_reloc(r_type)));
9953   if (static_reloc && gsym->needs_plt_entry())
9954     {
9955       target->make_plt_entry(symtab, layout, mips_sym, r_type);
9956
9957       // Since this is not a PC-relative relocation, we may be
9958       // taking the address of a function.  In that case we need to
9959       // set the entry in the dynamic symbol table to the address of
9960       // the PLT entry.
9961       if (gsym->is_from_dynobj() && !parameters->options().shared())
9962         {
9963           gsym->set_needs_dynsym_value();
9964           // We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
9965           // giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT.  Set the
9966           // flag if there are any relocations in the binary where pointer
9967           // equality matters.
9968           if (mips_sym->pointer_equality_needed())
9969             mips_sym->set_mips_plt();
9970         }
9971     }
9972   if ((static_reloc || can_make_dynamic) && !gp_disp_against_hi16)
9973     {
9974       // Absolute addressing relocations.
9975       // Make a dynamic relocation if necessary.
9976       if (gsym->needs_dynamic_reloc(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type)))
9977         {
9978           if (gsym->may_need_copy_reloc())
9979             {
9980               target->copy_reloc(symtab, layout, object, data_shndx,
9981                                  output_section, gsym, r_type, r_offset);
9982             }
9983           else if (can_make_dynamic)
9984             {
9985               // Create .rel.dyn section.
9986               target->rel_dyn_section(layout);
9987               target->dynamic_reloc(mips_sym, elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32, mips_obj,
9988                                     data_shndx, output_section, r_offset);
9989             }
9990           else
9991             gold_error(_("non-dynamic relocations refer to dynamic symbol %s"),
9992                        gsym->name());
9993         }
9994     }
9995
9996   bool for_call = false;
9997   switch (r_type)
9998     {
9999     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
10000     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
10001     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
10002     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
10003     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
10004     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
10005     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
10006       for_call = true;
10007       // Fall through.
10008
10009     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
10010     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
10011     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
10012     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
10013     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
10014     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
10015     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
10016     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
10017     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
10018     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
10019       {
10020         // The symbol requires a GOT entry.
10021         Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
10022           target->got_section(symtab, layout);
10023         got->record_global_got_symbol(mips_sym, mips_obj, r_type, false,
10024                                       for_call);
10025         mips_sym->set_global_got_area(GGA_NORMAL);
10026       }
10027       break;
10028
10029     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
10030     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
10031       {
10032         // This relocation needs a page entry in the GOT.
10033         // Get the section contents.
10034         section_size_type view_size = 0;
10035         const unsigned char* view =
10036           object->section_contents(data_shndx, &view_size, false);
10037         view += r_offset;
10038
10039         Valtype32 val = elfcpp::Swap<32, big_endian>::readval(view);
10040         Valtype32 addend = (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL ? val & 0xffff
10041                                                         : r_addend);
10042         Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
10043           target->got_section(symtab, layout);
10044         got->record_got_page_entry(mips_obj, r_sym, addend);
10045
10046         // If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
10047         // decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it.
10048         bool def_regular = (mips_sym->source() == Symbol::FROM_OBJECT
10049                             && !mips_sym->object()->is_dynamic()
10050                             && !mips_sym->is_undefined());
10051         if (!def_regular
10052             || (parameters->options().output_is_position_independent()
10053                 && !parameters->options().Bsymbolic()
10054                 && !mips_sym->is_forced_local()))
10055           {
10056             got->record_global_got_symbol(mips_sym, mips_obj, r_type, false,
10057                                           for_call);
10058             mips_sym->set_global_got_area(GGA_NORMAL);
10059           }
10060       }
10061       break;
10062
10063     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10064     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10065     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10066     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
10067     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
10068     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
10069     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
10070     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
10071     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
10072       {
10073         const bool is_final = gsym->final_value_is_known();
10074         const tls::Tls_optimization optimized_type =
10075           Target_mips<size, big_endian>::optimize_tls_reloc(is_final, r_type);
10076
10077         switch (r_type)
10078           {
10079           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
10080           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
10081           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
10082             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
10083               {
10084                 // Create a pair of GOT entries for the module index and
10085                 // dtv-relative offset.
10086                 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
10087                   target->got_section(symtab, layout);
10088                 got->record_global_got_symbol(mips_sym, mips_obj, r_type, false,
10089                                               false);
10090               }
10091             else
10092               {
10093                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
10094                 gold_unreachable();
10095               }
10096             break;
10097
10098           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
10099           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
10100           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
10101             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
10102               {
10103                 // We always record LDM symbols as local with index 0.
10104                 target->got_section()->record_local_got_symbol(mips_obj, 0,
10105                                                                r_addend, r_type,
10106                                                                -1U, false);
10107               }
10108             else
10109               {
10110                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
10111                 gold_unreachable();
10112               }
10113             break;
10114           case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10115           case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10116           case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10117             layout->set_has_static_tls();
10118             if (optimized_type == tls::TLSOPT_NONE)
10119               {
10120                 // Create a GOT entry for the tp-relative offset.
10121                 Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got =
10122                   target->got_section(symtab, layout);
10123                 got->record_global_got_symbol(mips_sym, mips_obj, r_type, false,
10124                                               false);
10125               }
10126             else
10127               {
10128                 // FIXME: TLS optimization not supported yet.
10129                 gold_unreachable();
10130               }
10131             break;
10132
10133           default:
10134             gold_unreachable();
10135         }
10136       }
10137       break;
10138     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_COPY:
10139     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT:
10140       // These are relocations which should only be seen by the
10141       // dynamic linker, and should never be seen here.
10142       gold_error(_("%s: unexpected reloc %u in object file"),
10143                  object->name().c_str(), r_type);
10144       break;
10145
10146     default:
10147       break;
10148     }
10149
10150   // Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
10151   // shared library.  Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
10152   // not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
10153   // will be fine.  Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
10154   // combined with R_MIPS_GOT16.
10155   if (parameters->options().shared())
10156     {
10157       switch (r_type)
10158         {
10159         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
10160         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
10161         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
10162           // Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
10163           // no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation).
10164           if (r_sym == 0)
10165             break;
10166
10167           // R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
10168           // and has a special meaning.
10169           if (!mips_obj->is_newabi() && strcmp(gsym->name(), "_gp_disp") == 0)
10170             break;
10171
10172           // FALLTHROUGH
10173
10174         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
10175         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
10176         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
10177           gold_error(_("%s: relocation %u against `%s' can not be used when "
10178                        "making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC"),
10179                      object->name().c_str(), r_type, gsym->name());
10180         default:
10181           break;
10182         }
10183     }
10184 }
10185
10186 template<int size, bool big_endian>
10187 inline void
10188 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::global(
10189                                 Symbol_table* symtab,
10190                                 Layout* layout,
10191                                 Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
10192                                 Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
10193                                 unsigned int data_shndx,
10194                                 Output_section* output_section,
10195                                 const Relatype& reloc,
10196                                 unsigned int r_type,
10197                                 Symbol* gsym)
10198 {
10199   global(
10200     symtab,
10201     layout,
10202     target,
10203     object,
10204     data_shndx,
10205     output_section,
10206     &reloc,
10207     (const Reltype*) NULL,
10208     elfcpp::SHT_RELA,
10209     r_type,
10210     gsym);
10211 }
10212
10213 template<int size, bool big_endian>
10214 inline void
10215 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::global(
10216                                 Symbol_table* symtab,
10217                                 Layout* layout,
10218                                 Target_mips<size, big_endian>* target,
10219                                 Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
10220                                 unsigned int data_shndx,
10221                                 Output_section* output_section,
10222                                 const Reltype& reloc,
10223                                 unsigned int r_type,
10224                                 Symbol* gsym)
10225 {
10226   global(
10227     symtab,
10228     layout,
10229     target,
10230     object,
10231     data_shndx,
10232     output_section,
10233     (const Relatype*) NULL,
10234     &reloc,
10235     elfcpp::SHT_REL,
10236     r_type,
10237     gsym);
10238 }
10239
10240 // Return whether a R_MIPS_32/R_MIPS64 relocation needs to be applied.
10241 // In cases where Scan::local() or Scan::global() has created
10242 // a dynamic relocation, the addend of the relocation is carried
10243 // in the data, and we must not apply the static relocation.
10244
10245 template<int size, bool big_endian>
10246 inline bool
10247 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Relocate::should_apply_static_reloc(
10248     const Mips_symbol<size>* gsym,
10249     unsigned int r_type,
10250     Output_section* output_section,
10251     Target_mips* target)
10252 {
10253   // If the output section is not allocated, then we didn't call
10254   // scan_relocs, we didn't create a dynamic reloc, and we must apply
10255   // the reloc here.
10256   if ((output_section->flags() & elfcpp::SHF_ALLOC) == 0)
10257       return true;
10258
10259   if (gsym == NULL)
10260     return true;
10261   else
10262     {
10263       // For global symbols, we use the same helper routines used in the
10264       // scan pass.
10265       if (gsym->needs_dynamic_reloc(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type))
10266           && !gsym->may_need_copy_reloc())
10267         {
10268           // We have generated dynamic reloc (R_MIPS_REL32).
10269
10270           bool multi_got = false;
10271           if (target->has_got_section())
10272             multi_got = target->got_section()->multi_got();
10273           bool has_got_offset;
10274           if (!multi_got)
10275             has_got_offset = gsym->has_got_offset(GOT_TYPE_STANDARD);
10276           else
10277             has_got_offset = gsym->global_gotoffset() != -1U;
10278           if (!has_got_offset)
10279             return true;
10280           else
10281             // Apply the relocation only if the symbol is in the local got.
10282             // Do not apply the relocation if the symbol is in the global
10283             // got.
10284             return symbol_references_local(gsym, gsym->has_dynsym_index());
10285         }
10286       else
10287         // We have not generated dynamic reloc.
10288         return true;
10289     }
10290 }
10291
10292 // Perform a relocation.
10293
10294 template<int size, bool big_endian>
10295 inline bool
10296 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Relocate::relocate(
10297                         const Relocate_info<size, big_endian>* relinfo,
10298                         unsigned int rel_type,
10299                         Target_mips* target,
10300                         Output_section* output_section,
10301                         size_t relnum,
10302                         const unsigned char* preloc,
10303                         const Sized_symbol<size>* gsym,
10304                         const Symbol_value<size>* psymval,
10305                         unsigned char* view,
10306                         Mips_address address,
10307                         section_size_type)
10308 {
10309   Mips_address r_offset;
10310   unsigned int r_sym;
10311   unsigned int r_type;
10312   unsigned int r_type2;
10313   unsigned int r_type3;
10314   unsigned char r_ssym;
10315   typename elfcpp::Elf_types<size>::Elf_Swxword r_addend;
10316
10317   if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
10318     {
10319       const Relatype rela(preloc);
10320       r_offset = rela.get_r_offset();
10321       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
10322           get_r_sym(&rela);
10323       r_type = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
10324           get_r_type(&rela);
10325       r_type2 = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
10326           get_r_type2(&rela);
10327       r_type3 = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
10328           get_r_type3(&rela);
10329       r_ssym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_RELA, size, big_endian>::
10330           get_r_ssym(&rela);
10331       r_addend = rela.get_r_addend();
10332     }
10333   else
10334     {
10335       const Reltype rel(preloc);
10336       r_offset = rel.get_r_offset();
10337       r_sym = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::
10338           get_r_sym(&rel);
10339       r_type = Mips_classify_reloc<elfcpp::SHT_REL, size, big_endian>::
10340           get_r_type(&rel);
10341       r_ssym = 0;
10342       r_type2 = 0;
10343       r_type3 = 0;
10344       r_addend = 0;
10345     }
10346
10347   typedef Mips_relocate_functions<size, big_endian> Reloc_funcs;
10348   typename Reloc_funcs::Status reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OKAY;
10349
10350   Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>* object =
10351       Mips_relobj<size, big_endian>::as_mips_relobj(relinfo->object);
10352
10353   bool target_is_16_bit_code = false;
10354   bool target_is_micromips_code = false;
10355   bool cross_mode_jump;
10356
10357   Symbol_value<size> symval;
10358
10359   const Mips_symbol<size>* mips_sym = Mips_symbol<size>::as_mips_sym(gsym);
10360
10361   bool changed_symbol_value = false;
10362   if (gsym == NULL)
10363     {
10364       target_is_16_bit_code = object->local_symbol_is_mips16(r_sym);
10365       target_is_micromips_code = object->local_symbol_is_micromips(r_sym);
10366       if (target_is_16_bit_code || target_is_micromips_code)
10367         {
10368           // MIPS16/microMIPS text labels should be treated as odd.
10369           symval.set_output_value(psymval->value(object, 1));
10370           psymval = &symval;
10371           changed_symbol_value = true;
10372         }
10373     }
10374   else
10375     {
10376       target_is_16_bit_code = mips_sym->is_mips16();
10377       target_is_micromips_code = mips_sym->is_micromips();
10378
10379       // If this is a mips16/microMIPS text symbol, add 1 to the value to make
10380       // it odd.  This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
10381       // the right value when it is loaded into the PC.
10382
10383       if ((mips_sym->is_mips16() || mips_sym->is_micromips())
10384           && psymval->value(object, 0) != 0)
10385         {
10386           symval.set_output_value(psymval->value(object, 0) | 1);
10387           psymval = &symval;
10388           changed_symbol_value = true;
10389         }
10390
10391       // Pick the value to use for symbols defined in shared objects.
10392       if (mips_sym->use_plt_offset(Scan::get_reference_flags(r_type))
10393           || mips_sym->has_lazy_stub())
10394         {
10395           Mips_address value;
10396           if (!mips_sym->has_lazy_stub())
10397             {
10398               // Prefer a standard MIPS PLT entry.
10399               if (mips_sym->has_mips_plt_offset())
10400                 {
10401                   value = target->plt_section()->mips_entry_address(mips_sym);
10402                   target_is_micromips_code = false;
10403                   target_is_16_bit_code = false;
10404                 }
10405               else
10406                 {
10407                   value = (target->plt_section()->comp_entry_address(mips_sym)
10408                            + 1);
10409                   if (target->is_output_micromips())
10410                     target_is_micromips_code = true;
10411                   else
10412                     target_is_16_bit_code = true;
10413                 }
10414             }
10415           else
10416             value = target->mips_stubs_section()->stub_address(mips_sym);
10417
10418           symval.set_output_value(value);
10419           psymval = &symval;
10420         }
10421     }
10422
10423   // TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp".
10424   // Note that such a symbol must always be a global symbol.
10425   bool gp_disp = (gsym != NULL && (strcmp(gsym->name(), "_gp_disp") == 0)
10426                   && !object->is_newabi());
10427
10428   // TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "__gnu_local_gp".
10429   // Note that such a symbol must always be a global symbol.
10430   bool gnu_local_gp = gsym && (strcmp(gsym->name(), "__gnu_local_gp") == 0);
10431
10432
10433   if (gp_disp)
10434     {
10435       if (!hi16_reloc(r_type) && !lo16_reloc(r_type))
10436         gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, r_offset,
10437           _("relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only"
10438             " with R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations."));
10439     }
10440   else if (gnu_local_gp)
10441     {
10442       // __gnu_local_gp is _gp symbol.
10443       symval.set_output_value(target->adjusted_gp_value(object));
10444       psymval = &symval;
10445     }
10446
10447   // If this is a reference to a 16-bit function with a stub, we need
10448   // to redirect the relocation to the stub unless:
10449   //
10450   // (a) the relocation is for a MIPS16 JAL;
10451   //
10452   // (b) the relocation is for a MIPS16 PIC call, and there are no
10453   //     non-MIPS16 uses of the GOT slot; or
10454   //
10455   // (c) the section allows direct references to MIPS16 functions.
10456   if (r_type != elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26
10457       && !parameters->options().relocatable()
10458       && ((mips_sym != NULL
10459            && mips_sym->has_mips16_fn_stub()
10460            && (r_type != elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16 || mips_sym->need_fn_stub()))
10461           || (mips_sym == NULL
10462               && object->get_local_mips16_fn_stub(r_sym) != NULL))
10463       && !object->section_allows_mips16_refs(relinfo->data_shndx))
10464     {
10465       // This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function.  We should
10466       // have already noticed that we were going to need the
10467       // stub.
10468       Mips_address value;
10469       if (mips_sym == NULL)
10470         value = object->get_local_mips16_fn_stub(r_sym)->output_address();
10471       else
10472         {
10473           gold_assert(mips_sym->need_fn_stub());
10474           if (mips_sym->has_la25_stub())
10475             value = target->la25_stub_section()->stub_address(mips_sym);
10476           else
10477             {
10478               value = mips_sym->template
10479                       get_mips16_fn_stub<big_endian>()->output_address();
10480             }
10481           }
10482       symval.set_output_value(value);
10483       psymval = &symval;
10484       changed_symbol_value = true;
10485
10486       // The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't.
10487       target_is_16_bit_code = false;
10488     }
10489   // If this is a MIPS16 call with a stub, that is made through the PLT or
10490   // to a standard MIPS function, we need to redirect the call to the stub.
10491   // Note that we specifically exclude R_MIPS16_CALL16 from this behavior;
10492   // indirect calls should use an indirect stub instead.
10493   else if (r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26 && !parameters->options().relocatable()
10494            && ((mips_sym != NULL
10495                 && (mips_sym->has_mips16_call_stub()
10496                     || mips_sym->has_mips16_call_fp_stub()))
10497                || (mips_sym == NULL
10498                    && object->get_local_mips16_call_stub(r_sym) != NULL))
10499            && ((mips_sym != NULL && mips_sym->has_plt_offset())
10500                || !target_is_16_bit_code))
10501     {
10502       Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* call_stub;
10503       if (mips_sym == NULL)
10504         call_stub = object->get_local_mips16_call_stub(r_sym);
10505       else
10506         {
10507           // If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
10508           // out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
10509           // file.
10510           if (mips_sym->has_mips16_call_stub()
10511               && mips_sym->has_mips16_call_fp_stub())
10512             {
10513               call_stub = NULL;
10514               for (unsigned int i = 1; i < object->shnum(); ++i)
10515                 {
10516                   if (object->is_mips16_call_fp_stub_section(i))
10517                     {
10518                       call_stub = mips_sym->template
10519                                   get_mips16_call_fp_stub<big_endian>();
10520                       break;
10521                     }
10522
10523                 }
10524               if (call_stub == NULL)
10525                 call_stub =
10526                   mips_sym->template get_mips16_call_stub<big_endian>();
10527             }
10528           else if (mips_sym->has_mips16_call_stub())
10529             call_stub = mips_sym->template get_mips16_call_stub<big_endian>();
10530           else
10531             call_stub = mips_sym->template get_mips16_call_fp_stub<big_endian>();
10532         }
10533
10534       symval.set_output_value(call_stub->output_address());
10535       psymval = &symval;
10536       changed_symbol_value = true;
10537     }
10538   // If this is a direct call to a PIC function, redirect to the
10539   // non-PIC stub.
10540   else if (mips_sym != NULL
10541            && mips_sym->has_la25_stub()
10542            && relocation_needs_la25_stub<size, big_endian>(
10543                                        object, r_type, target_is_16_bit_code))
10544     {
10545       Mips_address value = target->la25_stub_section()->stub_address(mips_sym);
10546       if (mips_sym->is_micromips())
10547         value += 1;
10548       symval.set_output_value(value);
10549       psymval = &symval;
10550     }
10551   // For direct MIPS16 and microMIPS calls make sure the compressed PLT
10552   // entry is used if a standard PLT entry has also been made.
10553   else if ((r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26
10554             || r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
10555           && !parameters->options().relocatable()
10556           && mips_sym != NULL
10557           && mips_sym->has_plt_offset()
10558           && mips_sym->has_comp_plt_offset()
10559           && mips_sym->has_mips_plt_offset())
10560     {
10561       Mips_address value = (target->plt_section()->comp_entry_address(mips_sym)
10562                             + 1);
10563       symval.set_output_value(value);
10564       psymval = &symval;
10565
10566       target_is_16_bit_code = !target->is_output_micromips();
10567       target_is_micromips_code = target->is_output_micromips();
10568     }
10569
10570   // Make sure MIPS16 and microMIPS are not used together.
10571   if ((r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26 && target_is_micromips_code)
10572       || (micromips_branch_reloc(r_type) && target_is_16_bit_code))
10573    {
10574       gold_error(_("MIPS16 and microMIPS functions cannot call each other"));
10575    }
10576
10577   // Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
10578   // mode change.  However, we can ignore calls to undefined weak symbols,
10579   // which should never be executed at runtime.  This exception is important
10580   // because the assembly writer may have "known" that any definition of the
10581   // symbol would be 16-bit code, and that direct jumps were therefore
10582   // acceptable.
10583   cross_mode_jump =
10584     (!parameters->options().relocatable()
10585      && !(gsym != NULL && gsym->is_weak_undefined())
10586      && ((r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26 && !target_is_16_bit_code)
10587          || (r_type == elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 && !target_is_micromips_code)
10588          || ((r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_26 || r_type == elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR)
10589              && (target_is_16_bit_code || target_is_micromips_code))));
10590
10591   bool local = (mips_sym == NULL
10592                 || (mips_sym->got_only_for_calls()
10593                     ? symbol_calls_local(mips_sym, mips_sym->has_dynsym_index())
10594                     : symbol_references_local(mips_sym,
10595                                               mips_sym->has_dynsym_index())));
10596
10597   // Global R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE relocations are equivalent
10598   // to R_MIPS_GOT_DISP/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP.  The addend is applied by the
10599   // corresponding R_MIPS_GOT_OFST/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST.
10600   if (got_page_reloc(r_type) && !local)
10601     r_type = (micromips_reloc(r_type) ? elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP
10602                                       : elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP);
10603
10604   unsigned int got_offset = 0;
10605   int gp_offset = 0;
10606
10607   bool calculate_only = false;
10608   Valtype calculated_value = 0;
10609   bool extract_addend = rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL;
10610   unsigned int r_types[3] = { r_type, r_type2, r_type3 };
10611
10612   Reloc_funcs::mips_reloc_unshuffle(view, r_type, false);
10613
10614   // For Mips64 N64 ABI, there may be up to three operations specified per
10615   // record, by the fields r_type, r_type2, and r_type3. The first operation
10616   // takes its addend from the relocation record. Each subsequent operation
10617   // takes as its addend the result of the previous operation.
10618   // The first operation in a record which references a symbol uses the symbol
10619   // implied by r_sym. The next operation in a record which references a symbol
10620   // uses the special symbol value given by the r_ssym field. A third operation
10621   // in a record which references a symbol will assume a NULL symbol,
10622   // i.e. value zero.
10623
10624   // TODO(Vladimir)
10625   // Check if a record references to a symbol.
10626   for (unsigned int i = 0; i < 3; ++i)
10627     {
10628       if (r_types[i] == elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE)
10629         break;
10630
10631       // TODO(Vladimir)
10632       // Check if the next relocation is for the same instruction.
10633       calculate_only = i == 2 ? false
10634                               : r_types[i+1] != elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE;
10635
10636       if (object->is_n64())
10637         {
10638           if (i == 1)
10639             {
10640               // Handle special symbol for r_type2 relocation type.
10641               switch (r_ssym)
10642                 {
10643                 case RSS_UNDEF:
10644                   symval.set_output_value(0);
10645                   break;
10646                 case RSS_GP:
10647                   symval.set_output_value(target->gp_value());
10648                   break;
10649                 case RSS_GP0:
10650                   symval.set_output_value(object->gp_value());
10651                   break;
10652                 case RSS_LOC:
10653                   symval.set_output_value(address);
10654                   break;
10655                 default:
10656                   gold_unreachable();
10657                 }
10658               psymval = &symval;
10659             }
10660           else if (i == 2)
10661            {
10662             // For r_type3 symbol value is 0.
10663             symval.set_output_value(0);
10664            }
10665         }
10666
10667       bool update_got_entry = false;
10668       switch (r_types[i])
10669         {
10670         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE:
10671           break;
10672         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_16:
10673           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel16(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
10674                                             extract_addend, calculate_only,
10675                                             &calculated_value);
10676           break;
10677
10678         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_32:
10679           if (should_apply_static_reloc(mips_sym, r_types[i], output_section,
10680                                         target))
10681             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel32(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
10682                                               extract_addend, calculate_only,
10683                                               &calculated_value);
10684           if (mips_sym != NULL
10685               && (mips_sym->is_mips16() || mips_sym->is_micromips())
10686               && mips_sym->global_got_area() == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
10687             {
10688               // If mips_sym->has_mips16_fn_stub() is false, symbol value is
10689               // already updated by adding +1.
10690               if (mips_sym->has_mips16_fn_stub())
10691                 {
10692                   gold_assert(mips_sym->need_fn_stub());
10693                   Mips16_stub_section<size, big_endian>* fn_stub =
10694                     mips_sym->template get_mips16_fn_stub<big_endian>();
10695
10696                   symval.set_output_value(fn_stub->output_address());
10697                   psymval = &symval;
10698                 }
10699               got_offset = mips_sym->global_gotoffset();
10700               update_got_entry = true;
10701             }
10702           break;
10703
10704         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_64:
10705           if (should_apply_static_reloc(mips_sym, r_types[i], output_section,
10706                                         target))
10707             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel64(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
10708                                               extract_addend, calculate_only,
10709                                               &calculated_value, false);
10710           else if (target->is_output_n64() && r_addend != 0)
10711             // Only apply the addend.  The static relocation was RELA, but the
10712             // dynamic relocation is REL, so we need to apply the addend.
10713             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel64(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
10714                                               extract_addend, calculate_only,
10715                                               &calculated_value, true);
10716           break;
10717         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32:
10718           gold_unreachable();
10719
10720         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC32:
10721           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relpc32(view, object, psymval, address,
10722                                               r_addend, extract_addend,
10723                                               calculate_only,
10724                                               &calculated_value);
10725           break;
10726
10727         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
10728           // The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
10729           // R_MIPS_26.  It's only the storage of the relocated field into
10730           // the output file that's different.  So, we just fall through to the
10731           // R_MIPS_26 case here.
10732         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
10733         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
10734           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rel26(view, object, psymval, address,
10735               gsym == NULL, r_addend, extract_addend, gsym, cross_mode_jump,
10736               r_types[i], target->jal_to_bal(), calculate_only,
10737               &calculated_value);
10738           break;
10739
10740         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
10741         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
10742         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
10743           if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
10744             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::do_relhi16(view, object, psymval,
10745                                                    r_addend, address,
10746                                                    gp_disp, r_types[i],
10747                                                    extract_addend, 0,
10748                                                    target, calculate_only,
10749                                                    &calculated_value);
10750           else if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
10751             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relhi16(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
10752                                                 address, gp_disp, r_types[i],
10753                                                 r_sym, extract_addend);
10754           else
10755             gold_unreachable();
10756           break;
10757
10758         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16:
10759         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16:
10760         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
10761         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16:
10762           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::rello16(target, view, object, psymval,
10763                                               r_addend, extract_addend, address,
10764                                               gp_disp, r_types[i], r_sym,
10765                                               rel_type, calculate_only,
10766                                               &calculated_value);
10767           break;
10768
10769         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LITERAL:
10770         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
10771           // Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
10772           // just like R_MIPS_GPREL16.  In the long run, we should merge
10773           // shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
10774           // here.
10775
10776           // Fall through.
10777
10778         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL16:
10779         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GPREL:
10780         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
10781         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
10782           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgprel(view, object, psymval,
10783                                              target->adjusted_gp_value(object),
10784                                              r_addend, extract_addend,
10785                                              gsym == NULL, r_types[i],
10786                                              calculate_only, &calculated_value);
10787           break;
10788
10789         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC16:
10790           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relpc16(view, object, psymval, address,
10791                                               r_addend, extract_addend,
10792                                               calculate_only,
10793                                               &calculated_value);
10794           break;
10795         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
10796           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relmicromips_pc7_s1(view, object, psymval,
10797                                                         address, r_addend,
10798                                                         extract_addend,
10799                                                         calculate_only,
10800                                                         &calculated_value);
10801           break;
10802         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
10803           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relmicromips_pc10_s1(view, object,
10804                                                        psymval, address,
10805                                                        r_addend, extract_addend,
10806                                                        calculate_only,
10807                                                        &calculated_value);
10808           break;
10809         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
10810           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relmicromips_pc16_s1(view, object,
10811                                                        psymval, address,
10812                                                        r_addend, extract_addend,
10813                                                        calculate_only,
10814                                                        &calculated_value);
10815           break;
10816         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL32:
10817           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgprel32(view, object, psymval,
10818                                               target->adjusted_gp_value(object),
10819                                               r_addend, extract_addend,
10820                                               calculate_only,
10821                                               &calculated_value);
10822           break;
10823         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
10824         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
10825         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
10826         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
10827           if (gsym != NULL)
10828             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10829                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10830                                                            object);
10831           else
10832             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(r_sym,
10833                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10834                                                            object, r_addend);
10835           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10836           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot_hi16(view, gp_offset,
10837                                                   calculate_only,
10838                                                   &calculated_value);
10839           update_got_entry = changed_symbol_value;
10840           break;
10841
10842         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
10843         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
10844         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
10845         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
10846           if (gsym != NULL)
10847             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10848                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10849                                                            object);
10850           else
10851             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(r_sym,
10852                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10853                                                            object, r_addend);
10854           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10855           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot_lo16(view, gp_offset,
10856                                                   calculate_only,
10857                                                   &calculated_value);
10858           update_got_entry = changed_symbol_value;
10859           break;
10860
10861         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
10862         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
10863         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
10864           if (gsym != NULL)
10865             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10866                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10867                                                            object);
10868           else
10869             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(r_sym,
10870                                                            GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10871                                                            object, r_addend);
10872           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10873           if (eh_reloc(r_types[i]))
10874             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::releh(view, gp_offset,
10875                                               calculate_only,
10876                                               &calculated_value);
10877           else
10878             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset,
10879                                                calculate_only,
10880                                                &calculated_value);
10881           break;
10882         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
10883         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
10884         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
10885           gold_assert(gsym != NULL);
10886           got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10887                                                          GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10888                                                          object);
10889           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10890           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset,
10891                                              calculate_only, &calculated_value);
10892           // TODO(sasa): We should also initialize update_got_entry
10893           // in other place swhere relgot is called.
10894           update_got_entry = changed_symbol_value;
10895           break;
10896
10897         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
10898         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
10899         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
10900           if (gsym != NULL)
10901             {
10902               got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10903                                                              GOT_TYPE_STANDARD,
10904                                                              object);
10905               gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10906               reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset,
10907                                                  calculate_only,
10908                                                  &calculated_value);
10909             }
10910           else
10911             {
10912               if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_RELA)
10913                 reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::do_relgot16_local(view, object,
10914                                                          psymval, r_addend,
10915                                                          extract_addend, 0,
10916                                                          target,
10917                                                          calculate_only,
10918                                                          &calculated_value);
10919               else if (rel_type == elfcpp::SHT_REL)
10920                 reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot16_local(view, object,
10921                                                            psymval, r_addend,
10922                                                            extract_addend,
10923                                                            r_types[i], r_sym);
10924               else
10925                 gold_unreachable();
10926             }
10927           update_got_entry = changed_symbol_value;
10928           break;
10929
10930         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
10931         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
10932         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
10933           if (gsym != NULL)
10934             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10935                                                            GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR,
10936                                                            object);
10937           else
10938             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(r_sym,
10939                                                            GOT_TYPE_TLS_PAIR,
10940                                                            object, r_addend);
10941           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10942           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset, calculate_only,
10943                                              &calculated_value);
10944           break;
10945
10946         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10947         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10948         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
10949           if (gsym != NULL)
10950             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(gsym,
10951                                                            GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET,
10952                                                            object);
10953           else
10954             got_offset = target->got_section()->got_offset(r_sym,
10955                                                            GOT_TYPE_TLS_OFFSET,
10956                                                            object, r_addend);
10957           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10958           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset, calculate_only,
10959                                              &calculated_value);
10960           break;
10961
10962         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
10963         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
10964         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
10965           // Relocate the field with the offset of the GOT entry for
10966           // the module index.
10967           got_offset = target->got_section()->tls_ldm_offset(object);
10968           gp_offset = target->got_section()->gp_offset(got_offset, object);
10969           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgot(view, gp_offset, calculate_only,
10970                                              &calculated_value);
10971           break;
10972
10973         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
10974         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
10975           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgotpage(target, view, object, psymval,
10976                                                  r_addend, extract_addend,
10977                                                  calculate_only,
10978                                                  &calculated_value);
10979           break;
10980
10981         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
10982         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
10983           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relgotofst(target, view, object, psymval,
10984                                                  r_addend, extract_addend,
10985                                                  local, calculate_only,
10986                                                  &calculated_value);
10987           break;
10988
10989         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR:
10990         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
10991           // This relocation is only a hint.  In some cases, we optimize
10992           // it into a bal instruction.  But we don't try to optimize
10993           // when the symbol does not resolve locally.
10994           if (gsym == NULL
10995               || symbol_calls_local(gsym, gsym->has_dynsym_index()))
10996             reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::reljalr(view, object, psymval, address,
10997                                                 r_addend, extract_addend,
10998                                                 cross_mode_jump, r_types[i],
10999                                                 target->jalr_to_bal(),
11000                                                 target->jr_to_b(),
11001                                                 calculate_only,
11002                                                 &calculated_value);
11003           break;
11004
11005         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
11006         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
11007         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
11008           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrelhi16(view, object, psymval,
11009                                                  elfcpp::DTP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11010                                                  extract_addend, calculate_only,
11011                                                  &calculated_value);
11012           break;
11013         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
11014         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
11015         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
11016           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrello16(view, object, psymval,
11017                                                  elfcpp::DTP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11018                                                  extract_addend, calculate_only,
11019                                                  &calculated_value);
11020           break;
11021         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
11022         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
11023           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrel32(view, object, psymval,
11024                                                elfcpp::DTP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11025                                                extract_addend, calculate_only,
11026                                                &calculated_value);
11027           break;
11028         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
11029         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
11030         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
11031           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrelhi16(view, object, psymval,
11032                                                  elfcpp::TP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11033                                                  extract_addend, calculate_only,
11034                                                  &calculated_value);
11035           break;
11036         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
11037         case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
11038         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
11039           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrello16(view, object, psymval,
11040                                                  elfcpp::TP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11041                                                  extract_addend, calculate_only,
11042                                                  &calculated_value);
11043           break;
11044         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
11045         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
11046           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::tlsrel32(view, object, psymval,
11047                                                elfcpp::TP_OFFSET, r_addend,
11048                                                extract_addend, calculate_only,
11049                                                &calculated_value);
11050           break;
11051         case elfcpp::R_MIPS_SUB:
11052         case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_SUB:
11053           reloc_status = Reloc_funcs::relsub(view, object, psymval, r_addend,
11054                                              extract_addend,
11055                                              calculate_only, &calculated_value);
11056           break;
11057         default:
11058           gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, r_offset,
11059                                  _("unsupported reloc %u"), r_types[i]);
11060           break;
11061         }
11062
11063       if (update_got_entry)
11064         {
11065           Mips_output_data_got<size, big_endian>* got = target->got_section();
11066           if (mips_sym != NULL && mips_sym->get_applied_secondary_got_fixup())
11067             got->update_got_entry(got->get_primary_got_offset(mips_sym),
11068                                   psymval->value(object, 0));
11069           else
11070             got->update_got_entry(got_offset, psymval->value(object, 0));
11071         }
11072
11073       r_addend = calculated_value;
11074     }
11075
11076   bool jal_shuffle = jal_reloc(r_type) ? !parameters->options().relocatable()
11077                                        : false;
11078   Reloc_funcs::mips_reloc_shuffle(view, r_type, jal_shuffle);
11079
11080   // Report any errors.
11081   switch (reloc_status)
11082     {
11083     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OKAY:
11084       break;
11085     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_OVERFLOW:
11086       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, r_offset,
11087                              _("relocation overflow"));
11088       break;
11089     case Reloc_funcs::STATUS_BAD_RELOC:
11090       gold_error_at_location(relinfo, relnum, r_offset,
11091         _("unexpected opcode while processing relocation"));
11092       break;
11093     default:
11094       gold_unreachable();
11095     }
11096
11097   return true;
11098 }
11099
11100 // Get the Reference_flags for a particular relocation.
11101
11102 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11103 int
11104 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::get_reference_flags(
11105                        unsigned int r_type)
11106 {
11107   switch (r_type)
11108     {
11109     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_NONE:
11110       // No symbol reference.
11111       return 0;
11112
11113     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_16:
11114     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_32:
11115     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_64:
11116     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_HI16:
11117     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LO16:
11118     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_HI16:
11119     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_LO16:
11120     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
11121     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
11122       return Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF;
11123
11124     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_26:
11125     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_26:
11126     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
11127       return Symbol::FUNCTION_CALL | Symbol::ABSOLUTE_REF;
11128
11129     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL32:
11130     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GPREL16:
11131     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_REL32:
11132     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GPREL:
11133       return Symbol::RELATIVE_REF;
11134
11135     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC16:
11136     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_PC32:
11137     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JALR:
11138     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
11139       return Symbol::FUNCTION_CALL | Symbol::RELATIVE_REF;
11140
11141     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT16:
11142     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL16:
11143     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
11144     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
11145     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
11146     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
11147     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
11148     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_LITERAL:
11149     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
11150     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
11151     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_GOT16:
11152     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_CALL16:
11153     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
11154     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
11155     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
11156     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
11157     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
11158     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
11159     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_EH:
11160       // Absolute in GOT.
11161       return Symbol::RELATIVE_REF;
11162
11163     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32:
11164     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
11165     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64:
11166     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
11167     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
11168     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
11169     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
11170     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
11171     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
11172     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
11173     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
11174     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
11175     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
11176     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
11177     case elfcpp::R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
11178     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
11179     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
11180     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
11181     case elfcpp::R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
11182       return Symbol::TLS_REF;
11183
11184     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_COPY:
11185     case elfcpp::R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT:
11186     default:
11187       gold_unreachable();
11188       // Not expected.  We will give an error later.
11189       return 0;
11190     }
11191 }
11192
11193 // Report an unsupported relocation against a local symbol.
11194
11195 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11196 void
11197 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::unsupported_reloc_local(
11198                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
11199                         unsigned int r_type)
11200 {
11201   gold_error(_("%s: unsupported reloc %u against local symbol"),
11202              object->name().c_str(), r_type);
11203 }
11204
11205 // Report an unsupported relocation against a global symbol.
11206
11207 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11208 void
11209 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::Scan::unsupported_reloc_global(
11210                         Sized_relobj_file<size, big_endian>* object,
11211                         unsigned int r_type,
11212                         Symbol* gsym)
11213 {
11214   gold_error(_("%s: unsupported reloc %u against global symbol %s"),
11215              object->name().c_str(), r_type, gsym->demangled_name().c_str());
11216 }
11217
11218 // Return printable name for ABI.
11219 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11220 const char*
11221 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::elf_mips_abi_name(elfcpp::Elf_Word e_flags)
11222 {
11223   switch (e_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI)
11224     {
11225     case 0:
11226       if ((e_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
11227         return "N32";
11228       else if (size == 64)
11229         return "64";
11230       else
11231         return "none";
11232     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
11233       return "O32";
11234     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
11235       return "O64";
11236     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
11237       return "EABI32";
11238     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
11239       return "EABI64";
11240     default:
11241       return "unknown abi";
11242     }
11243 }
11244
11245 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11246 const char*
11247 Target_mips<size, big_endian>::elf_mips_mach_name(elfcpp::Elf_Word e_flags)
11248 {
11249   switch (e_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_MACH)
11250     {
11251     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
11252       return "mips:3900";
11253     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
11254       return "mips:4010";
11255     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
11256       return "mips:4100";
11257     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
11258       return "mips:4111";
11259     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
11260       return "mips:4120";
11261     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
11262       return "mips:4650";
11263     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
11264       return "mips:5400";
11265     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
11266       return "mips:5500";
11267     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
11268       return "mips:sb1";
11269     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
11270       return "mips:9000";
11271     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
11272       return "mips:loongson-2e";
11273     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
11274       return "mips:loongson-2f";
11275     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_LS3A:
11276       return "mips:loongson-3a";
11277     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
11278       return "mips:octeon";
11279     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2:
11280       return "mips:octeon2";
11281     case elfcpp::E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
11282       return "mips:xlr";
11283     default:
11284       switch (e_flags & elfcpp::EF_MIPS_ARCH)
11285         {
11286         default:
11287         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
11288           return "mips:3000";
11289
11290         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
11291           return "mips:6000";
11292
11293         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
11294           return "mips:4000";
11295
11296         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
11297           return "mips:8000";
11298
11299         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
11300           return "mips:mips5";
11301
11302         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
11303           return "mips:isa32";
11304
11305         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
11306           return "mips:isa64";
11307
11308         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
11309           return "mips:isa32r2";
11310
11311         case elfcpp::E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
11312           return "mips:isa64r2";
11313         }
11314     }
11315     return "unknown CPU";
11316 }
11317
11318 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11319 const Target::Target_info Target_mips<size, big_endian>::mips_info =
11320 {
11321   size,                 // size
11322   big_endian,           // is_big_endian
11323   elfcpp::EM_MIPS,      // machine_code
11324   true,                 // has_make_symbol
11325   false,                // has_resolve
11326   false,                // has_code_fill
11327   true,                 // is_default_stack_executable
11328   false,                // can_icf_inline_merge_sections
11329   '\0',                 // wrap_char
11330   size == 32 ? "/lib/ld.so.1" : "/lib64/ld.so.1",      // dynamic_linker
11331   0x400000,             // default_text_segment_address
11332   64 * 1024,            // abi_pagesize (overridable by -z max-page-size)
11333   4 * 1024,             // common_pagesize (overridable by -z common-page-size)
11334   false,                // isolate_execinstr
11335   0,                    // rosegment_gap
11336   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // small_common_shndx
11337   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // large_common_shndx
11338   0,                    // small_common_section_flags
11339   0,                    // large_common_section_flags
11340   NULL,                 // attributes_section
11341   NULL,                 // attributes_vendor
11342   "__start",            // entry_symbol_name
11343   32,                   // hash_entry_size
11344 };
11345
11346 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11347 class Target_mips_nacl : public Target_mips<size, big_endian>
11348 {
11349  public:
11350   Target_mips_nacl()
11351     : Target_mips<size, big_endian>(&mips_nacl_info)
11352   { }
11353
11354  private:
11355   static const Target::Target_info mips_nacl_info;
11356 };
11357
11358 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11359 const Target::Target_info Target_mips_nacl<size, big_endian>::mips_nacl_info =
11360 {
11361   size,                 // size
11362   big_endian,           // is_big_endian
11363   elfcpp::EM_MIPS,      // machine_code
11364   true,                 // has_make_symbol
11365   false,                // has_resolve
11366   false,                // has_code_fill
11367   true,                 // is_default_stack_executable
11368   false,                // can_icf_inline_merge_sections
11369   '\0',                 // wrap_char
11370   "/lib/ld.so.1",       // dynamic_linker
11371   0x20000,              // default_text_segment_address
11372   0x10000,              // abi_pagesize (overridable by -z max-page-size)
11373   0x10000,              // common_pagesize (overridable by -z common-page-size)
11374   true,                 // isolate_execinstr
11375   0x10000000,           // rosegment_gap
11376   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // small_common_shndx
11377   elfcpp::SHN_UNDEF,    // large_common_shndx
11378   0,                    // small_common_section_flags
11379   0,                    // large_common_section_flags
11380   NULL,                 // attributes_section
11381   NULL,                 // attributes_vendor
11382   "_start",             // entry_symbol_name
11383   32,                   // hash_entry_size
11384 };
11385
11386 // Target selector for Mips.  Note this is never instantiated directly.
11387 // It's only used in Target_selector_mips_nacl, below.
11388
11389 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11390 class Target_selector_mips : public Target_selector
11391 {
11392 public:
11393   Target_selector_mips()
11394     : Target_selector(elfcpp::EM_MIPS, size, big_endian,
11395                 (size == 64 ?
11396                   (big_endian ? "elf64-tradbigmips" : "elf64-tradlittlemips") :
11397                   (big_endian ? "elf32-tradbigmips" : "elf32-tradlittlemips")),
11398                 (size == 64 ?
11399                   (big_endian ? "elf64btsmip" : "elf64ltsmip") :
11400                   (big_endian ? "elf32btsmip" : "elf32ltsmip")))
11401   { }
11402
11403   Target* do_instantiate_target()
11404   { return new Target_mips<size, big_endian>(); }
11405 };
11406
11407 template<int size, bool big_endian>
11408 class Target_selector_mips_nacl
11409   : public Target_selector_nacl<Target_selector_mips<size, big_endian>,
11410                                 Target_mips_nacl<size, big_endian> >
11411 {
11412  public:
11413   Target_selector_mips_nacl()
11414     : Target_selector_nacl<Target_selector_mips<size, big_endian>,
11415                            Target_mips_nacl<size, big_endian> >(
11416         // NaCl currently supports only MIPS32 little-endian.
11417         "mipsel", "elf32-tradlittlemips-nacl", "elf32-tradlittlemips-nacl")
11418   { }
11419 };
11420
11421 Target_selector_mips_nacl<32, true> target_selector_mips32;
11422 Target_selector_mips_nacl<32, false> target_selector_mips32el;
11423 Target_selector_mips_nacl<64, true> target_selector_mips64;
11424 Target_selector_mips_nacl<64, false> target_selector_mips64el;
11425
11426 } // End anonymous namespace.